Panasonic HC X1 Operating Instructions IM EN

User Manual: panasonic HC-X1 - Operating Instructions Free User Guide for Panasonic Camcorder, Manual - page1

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 232

DownloadPanasonic HC-X1 - Operating Instructions IM EN
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

1 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Operating Instructions
4K Video Camera
Model No.

HC-X1

Please read these instructions carefully before using this product, and save this manual for future use.

E

DVQP1176ZA

GC

until
2016/10/28

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

2 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Information for Your Safety
Before use

For the AC mains plug of three pins

∫ Caution for AC mains lead

Remove the connector cover.

For your safety, please read the following text
carefully.

How to replace the fuse

This appliance is supplied with a moulded three
pin mains plug for your safety and convenience.
A 5-ampere fuse is fitted in this plug.
Should the fuse need to be replaced please
ensure that the replacement fuse has a rating of
5-ampere and that it is approved by ASTA or
BSI to BS1362.
Check for the ASTA mark Ï or the BSI mark Ì
on the body of the fuse.
If the plug contains a removable fuse cover you
must ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is
replaced.
If you lose the fuse cover the plug must not be
used until a replacement cover is obtained.
A replacement fuse cover can be purchased
from your local dealer.

The location of the fuse differ according to the
type of AC mains plug (figures A and B).
Confirm the AC mains plug fitted and follow the
instructions below.
Illustrations may differ from actual AC mains
plug.

1.

Open the fuse cover with a screwdriver.

2.

Replace the fuse and close or attach the
fuse cover.

WARNING:
To reduce the risk of fire, electric shock or product damage,
≥ Do not expose this unit to rain, moisture, dripping or splashing.
≥ Do not place objects filled with liquids, such as vases, on this unit.
≥ Use only the recommended accessories.
≥ Do not remove covers.
≥ Do not repair this unit by yourself. Refer servicing to qualified service personnel.

CAUTION!
To reduce the risk of fire, electric shock or product damage,
≥ Do not install or place this unit in a bookcase, built-in cabinet or in another confined space.
Ensure this unit is well ventilated.
≥ Do not obstruct this unit’s ventilation openings with newspapers, tablecloths, curtains, and
similar items.
≥ Do not place sources of naked flames, such as lighted candles, on this unit.
The mains plug is the disconnecting device. Install this unit so that the mains plug can be
unplugged from the socket outlet immediately.
This unit is intended for use in moderate climates. (HC-X1E)
This unit is intended for use in moderate and tropical climates. (HC-X1GC)

-2-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

3 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Concerning the battery
Warning
Risk of fire, explosion and burns. Do not disassemble, heat above 60 oC or incinerate.

CAUTION
≥ Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the type
recommended by the manufacturer.
≥ When disposing of the batteries, please contact your local authorities or dealer and ask for the
correct method of disposal.
For Europe only

∫ EMC Electric and magnetic compatibility
This symbol (CE) is located on the rating plate.

∫ Product identification marking
Product

Location

4K Video Camera

Bottom

Battery charger

Bottom

AC adaptor

Bottom

∫ Disposal of Old Equipment and
Batteries
Only for European Union and
countries with recycling
systems
These symbols on the
products, packaging, and/
or accompanying
documents mean that
used electrical and
electronic products and
batteries must not be
mixed with general
household waste.
For proper treatment, recovery and
recycling of old products and used
batteries, please take them to applicable
collection points in accordance with your
national legislation.
By disposing of them correctly, you will
help to save valuable resources and

prevent any potential negative effects on
human health and the environment.
For more information about collection and
recycling, please contact your local
municipality.
Penalties may be applicable for incorrect
disposal of this waste, in accordance with
national legislation.
Note for the battery
symbol (bottom symbol):
This symbol might be used
in combination with a
chemical symbol. In this
case it complies with the
requirement set by the
Directive for the chemical involved.
AEEE Yönetmeliğine Uygundur.
AEEE Complies with Directive of Turkey.

-3-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

4 ページ

2016年11月28日

Note regarding the Power Management
function specified under COMMISSION
REGULATION (EC) No 1275/2008
implementing Directive 2009/125/EC of the
European Parliament and of the Council.
This device is designed and manufactured for
use at a broadcasting station and/or in a similar
environment.
This device is not equipped with a Power
Management function or the Power
Management function is set to OFF as it will
prevent the device from fulfilling its intended
purpose for the reasons below.
1.

If the device is a Studio Camera, a Weather
Camera, a Mixer or other processor:

A Power Management function may
cause the device to suddenly stop
during recording or while On Air.
2.

午前11時40分

≥ Recorded data may be damaged, or pictures
may be distorted, by strong magnetic fields
created by speakers or large motors.
≥ Electromagnetic wave radiation generated by
microprocessors may adversely affect this
unit, disturbing the pictures and/or sound.
≥ If this unit is adversely affected by
electromagnetic equipment and stops
functioning properly, turn this unit off and
remove the battery or disconnect AC adaptor.
Then reinsert the battery or reconnect AC
adaptor and turn this unit on.
Do not use this unit near radio transmitters
or high-voltage lines.
≥ If you record near radio transmitters or
high-voltage lines, the recorded pictures and/
or sound may be adversely affected.
About connecting to a PC
≥ A USB 3.0 cable is not supplied with this unit.
Use a commercially-available doubleshielded USB 3.0 cable with a ferrite core.
If possible, we recommend using a cable with
a length of 1.5 m or less.

If the device is a Studio Monitor:

A Power Management function may
cause video for the confirmation of
whether a signal is normal, or whether
the signal has been lost, to be unviewable.
3.

月曜日

If the device is a Camera Recorder:

A professional camera recorder must be
able to start quickly at any time, but a
Power Management function will cause
an increase in the time taken to resume
from Stand-by mode.

∫ Cautions for use

About using a headphone
≥ Excessive sound pressure from earphones
and headphones can cause hearing loss.
≥ Listening at full volume for long periods may
damage the user’s ears.
Make sure to use the supplied cords and
cables. If you use optional accessories, use the
cords and the cables supplied with them.
Do not extend the cords and the cables.
Do not spray insecticides or volatile
chemicals onto the unit.
≥ If the unit is sprayed with such chemicals, its body
may be marred and the surface finish may peel off.
≥ Do not leave rubber or plastic products in
contact with the unit for a long time.

About this unit
The unit and the SD card become warm
during use. This is not a malfunction.
Keep this unit as far away as possible from
electromagnetic equipment (such as
microwave ovens, TVs, video games etc.).
≥ If you use this unit on top of or near a TV, the
pictures and/or sound on this unit may be
disrupted by electromagnetic wave radiation.
≥ Do not use this unit near cell phones because
doing so may result in noise adversely
affecting the pictures and/or sound.

When you use the unit in a sandy or dusty
place such as a beach, do not let sand or fine
dust get into the body and terminals of the unit.
Also, keep the unit away from sea water.
≥ Sand or dust may damage the unit. (Care should
be taken when inserting and removing a card.)
≥ If sea water splashes onto the unit, wipe off
the water with a well wrung cloth. Then wipe
the unit again with a dry cloth.

-4-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

5 ページ

2016年11月28日

When carrying the unit, do not drop or bump it.
≥ A strong impact can break the unit’s casing,
causing it to malfunction.
≥ When carrying this unit, please hold the
handle, hand strap or shoulder strap firmly
and treat it with care.
Cleaning
≥ Before cleaning, detach the battery or pull the
AC cable from the AC outlet, and then wipe
the unit with a soft, dry cloth.
≥ If the unit is very dirty, dip a cloth in water and
squeeze firmly, and then wipe the unit with the
damp cloth. Next, dry the unit with a dry cloth.
≥ Use of benzine, paint thinner, alcohol, or
dishwashing liquid may alter the camera body
or peel the surface finish. Do not use these
solvents.
≥ When using a chemical dust cloth, follow the
instructions that came with the cloth.
When you are not going to use the unit for
an extended time
≥ When storing the unit, it is recommended that
you place a desiccant (silica gel) in with it.
Do not lift up this unit by the handle with the
tripod still attached
≥ When the tripod is attached, its weight will
also affect the unit’s handle, possibly causing
the handle to break and hurting the user.
≥ To carry the unit while the tripod is attached,
take hold of the tripod.
Do not swing the unit around, shake it by, or
allow it hang from the handle
≥ Do not jar, swing, or shake the unit by its
handle. Any strong jolt to the handle may
damage the unit or result in personal injury.
Do not allow the cord to drag on the ground
or pull a connected cord along the passage
≥ The cord will be damaged, causing fire or
electrical shock, when the cord gets caught by
the feet, excite will also cause personal injury.
When this unit is turned on, do not use it in direct
contact with the skin for a long period of time.
≥ When using this unit for a long period of time,
use a support such as a tripod. Low
temperature burns may result if any high
temperature part of this unit or hot air from
the ventilation openings on the front side of
the hand strap of this unit is in direct contact
with the skin for a long period of time.

月曜日

午前11時40分

About the battery
The battery used in this unit is a rechargeable
lithium-ion battery. It is susceptible to humidity
and temperature and the effect increases the
more the temperature rises or falls. In cold
areas, the full charge indication may not appear
or the low battery indication may appear about
5 minutes after starting use. At high
temperatures, the protection function may be
triggered, making it impossible to use the unit.
Be sure to detach the battery after use.
≥ If the battery is left attached, a minute amount
of current continues to flow even if the unit is
off. Keeping the unit in this state may result in
over discharge of the battery. This may result
in you not being able to use the battery even
after it is charged.
≥ The battery should be stored in the vinyl bag
so metal does not come into contact with the
terminals.
≥ The battery should be stored in a cool place
free from humidity, with as constant
temperature as possible. (Recommended
temperature: 15 oC to 25 oC, Recommended
humidity: 40%RH to 60%RH)
≥ Extremely high temperatures or low
temperatures will shorten the life of the battery.
≥ If the battery is kept in high-temperature,
high-humidity, or oily-smoky places, the
terminals may rust and cause malfunctions.
≥ To store the battery for a long period of time,
we recommend you charge it once every year
and store it again after you have completely
used up the charged capacity.
≥ Dust and other matter attached to the battery
terminals should be removed.
Prepare spare batteries when going out for
recording.
≥ Prepare batteries enough to last for 3 to 4
times the period you are planning to record
for. Cold places such as a ski resort can
shorten recording time.
If you drop the battery accidentally, check to
see if the terminals are damaged.
≥ When this unit or battery charger is attached
with the terminal part in a deformed state, this
unit or battery charger may be damaged.

-5-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

6 ページ

2016年11月28日

Do not throw old battery into fire.
≥ Heating a battery or throwing it into a fire may
result in an explosion.
If the operating time is very short even after
the battery has been recharged, the battery
has worn out. Please purchase a new battery.

About the AC adaptor/battery
charger
≥ If the temperature of the battery is extremely
high or extremely low, charging may take time
or the battery may not be charged.
≥ If the CHARGE indicators keeps flashing in
orange, make sure that the terminals of the
battery or the battery charger are not
exposed to dirt, foreign objects or dust, then
reconnect them properly.
Disconnect the AC cable from the AC outlet
when you remove dirt, foreign objects or dust
on the terminals of the battery or the battery
charger.
≥ If the battery’s temperature is excessively
high or excessively low, the CHARGE
indicators will blink orange. Charging will start
automatically when the battery reaches an
acceptable temperature for charging.
≥ If the CHARGE indicators blinks orange when
the battery’s temperature is normal, the battery
or the battery charger may be malfunctioning.
In such cases, contact your dealer.
≥ If you use the AC adaptor or battery charger
near a radio, radio reception may be
disturbed. Keep the AC adaptor or battery
charger 1 m or more away from the radio.
≥ When using the AC adaptor or battery charger, it may
generate whirring sounds. However, this is normal.
≥ After use, be sure to disconnect the AC cable from
the AC outlet. (If you leave this unit connected, the
AC adaptor will consume approximately 0.1 W.)
≥ Always keep the electrodes of the AC
adaptor, battery charger and battery clean.
≥ Install the device near an AC outlet so that
the power disconnection device (AC mains
plug) can be accessed easily by hand.

月曜日

午前11時40分

About the SD card
When disposing of or giving away the SD
card, note that:
≥ Formatting and deletion of this unit or computer
only changes the file management information and
does not completely delete the data in the SD card.
≥ It is recommended that the main SD card is
either physically destroyed or the SD card is
physically formatted using this unit when
disposing of or giving away the SD card.
≥ To physically format, connect this unit to the AC
adaptor, select [OTHER FUNCTION] #
[FORMAT MEDIA] # [SD CARD 1] or [SD
CARD 2] from the menu, and touch [YES].
Press and hold recording start/stop button in the
following screen for three seconds. Screen to
delete the SD card data is displayed, so select
[YES] and follow the instruction on the screen.

≥ The customer is responsible for the
management of the data in the SD card.

-6-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

7 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

LCD monitor/viewfinder

About personal information

≥ When the LCD screen is dirty or
condensation has occurred, please wipe it
using a soft cloth such as a lens cloth.
≥ Do not touch the LCD monitor with your finger
nails, or rub or press with strong force.
≥ It may become hard to see or hard to
recognize the touch when the LCD protection
sheet is affixed.
≥ When the unit has become very cold, for
example due to storage in a cold area, its
LCD monitor will be slightly darker than usual
immediately after the unit is turned on. The
normal brightness will be restored when the
unit’s internal temperature rises.

When this unit is connected to iPad, the SSID,
Password, and other personal information will
be included in this unit.
Setting a [NETWORK SETUP PASSWORD] is
recommended to protect personal information.
(l 200)

Extremely high precision technology is
employed to produce the LCD Monitor
screen. The result is more than 99.99%
effective dots with a mere 0.01% of the dots
inactive or always lit. However, this is not a
malfunction and does not affect the recorded
picture.
Extremely high precision technology is
employed to produce the viewfinder screen.
The result is more than 99.99% effective
dots with a mere 0.01% of the dots inactive
or always lit. However, this is not a
malfunction and does not affect the recorded
picture.

Disclaimer
≥ Information including personal information
may be altered or vanish due to erroneous
operation, effect of static electricity, accident,
malfunction, repair, or other handlings.
Please note in advance that Panasonic is not
liable in any way for any direct or indirect
damage from the alteration or vanishing of
information or personal information.
When requesting a repair, transferring to
another party, or disposing.
≥ After making a copy of personal information,
always delete information such as personal
information and wireless LAN connection
settings that you have saved within this unit with
[NETWORK INITIAL SETTING]/[INITIAL SET].
(l 198, 199)
≥ Remove the Memory Card from this unit
when requesting a repair.
≥ Settings may return to factory default when
this unit is repaired.
≥ Please contact the dealer where you
purchased this unit or Panasonic if above
operations are not possible due to malfunction.
When transferring to another party, or
disposing of the Memory Card, please refer
to “When disposing of or giving away the
SD card, note that:”. (l 6)

∫ About the recording method
for recording motion pictures
This unit can record motion pictures using three
different recording methods, including MOV,
MP4 and AVCHD*. (l 42, 160)
* AVCHD Progressive (1080/60p, 1080/50p)
supported.
MOV and MP4:
These recording methods are suitable for editing
images. Audio is recorded in linear PCM.
≥ Those methods are not compatible with
motion pictures recorded in AVCHD format.

-7-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

8 ページ

2016年11月28日

≥ Those methods can record motion pictures in
formats that support 4K. 4K motion pictures
offer a resolution four times higher than that
of full high-definition motion pictures.
AVCHD:
This recording method is suitable for playback
on a high-definition compatible external monitor.
Audio is recorded in Dolby® Digital.

∫ Regarding system frequencies

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ About security
Be careful about the possibility of theft or loss of
the unit, and be careful not to leave the unit
unattended. Please note that Panasonic does
not accept any responsibility for the
compromise, manipulation, and loss of
information caused by these events.

∫ Caution regarding laser beams
The lens may suffer damage if struck by a laser
beam. Make sure that laser beams do not strike
the lens when shooting in an environment
where laser devices are used.

You can change the system frequency
(59.94 Hz/50.00 Hz) for this unit by using the
menu. ([SYSTEM FREQ]: l 160, 197)
≥ You cannot store AVCHD scenes recorded
with different system frequencies on the
same SD card. If you have switched the
system frequency, use another SD card.

∫ Cards that you can use with
this unit
SDHC Memory Card and SDXC Memory Card
≥ 4 GB or more Memory Cards that do not have
the SDHC logo or 48 GB or more Memory
Cards that do not have the SDXC logo are
not based on SD Memory Card
Specifications.
≥ Refer to page 29 for more details on SD
cards.

∫ Indemnity about recorded
content
Panasonic does not accept any responsibility for
damages directly or indirectly due to any type of
problems that result in loss of recording or edited
content, and does not guarantee any content if
recording or editing does not work properly.
Likewise, the above also applies in a case where
any type of repair is made to the unit.

∫ For the purposes of these
operating instructions

∫ About Condensation
(When the lens, the viewfinder
or LCD Monitor is fogged up)
Condensation occurs when there is a change in
temperature or humidity, such as when the unit
is taken from outside or a cold room to a warm
room. Please be careful, as it may cause the
lens, the viewfinder or LCD monitor to become
soiled, moldy, or damaged.
When taking the unit to a place which has a
different temperature, if the unit is accustomed
to the room temperature of the destination for
about one hour, condensation can be
prevented. (When the difference in temperature
is severe, place the unit in a plastic bag or the
like, remove air from the bag, and seal the bag.)
When condensation has occurred, remove the
battery and/or the AC adapter and leave the
unit like that for about one hour. When the unit
becomes accustomed to the surrounding
temperature, fogginess will disappear naturally.

≥ The battery pack is referred to as the
“Battery”.
≥ SDHC Memory Card and SDXC Memory
Card are referred to as the “SD card”.
≥ Function that can be used for Recording
Mode:
Function that can be used for Playback
Mode:
≥ Scene(s) recorded with [REC MODE] set to
[MOV] or [MP4]: "MOV/MP4 scene(s)".
≥ Scene(s) recorded with [REC MODE] set to
[AVCHD]: "AVCHD scene(s)".
≥ Pages for reference are indicated by an
arrow, for example: l 00

-8-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

9 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Contents
Information for Your Safety ......................... 2
Accessories ................................................. 11
Optional accessories .................................. 12

Preparation
What you can do with this unit .................. 13
Recording to the SD card ...................... 13
Linking to external devices .................... 13
Remote operations with an iPad ............ 15
Names and Functions of Main Parts ......... 16
Power supply ............................................... 23
Charging the battery .............................. 23
Inserting/removing the battery ............... 25
Charging and recording time ................. 26
Connecting to the AC outlet ................... 28
Preparation of SD cards ............................. 29
Cards that you can use with this unit ..... 29
Inserting/removing an SD card .............. 30
Turning the unit on/off ................................ 31
Selecting a mode ........................................ 31
Using the LCD monitor/Viewfinder ............ 32
Setting how to turn on/off the LCD
monitor and Viewfinder .......................... 32
Using the LCD monitor .......................... 33
How to use the touch screen ................. 34
LCD monitor adjustment ........................ 35
Viewfinder adjustment ........................... 36
Recording yourself ................................. 37
Setting date and time .................................. 38
Using the menu screen .............................. 40

Recording
Before recording ......................................... 41
Selecting a media to record ....................... 41
Formatting media ................................... 42
Recording motion picture .......................... 42
Switching between Auto and
Manual Mode ............................................... 44
Adjusting the Picture Quality ..................... 46
Using the zoom ........................................... 48
Image Stabilizer Function .......................... 50
Focus ........................................................... 52
One Push AF ......................................... 55
Push AF ................................................. 56
Focus Assist .......................................... 56
Manual Focus Assist ............................. 59
Focus Transition .................................... 60

White Balance ..............................................63
Iris/Gain adjustment ....................................67
Iris adjustment ........................................67
Gain adjustment .....................................69
Manual shutter speed .................................71
Audio Input ..................................................74
Switching Audio Input ............................74
Adjusting the audio input level ...............76
Counter display ...........................................78
Setting the Time Code ...........................78
Setting the User Information ..................80
Setting the Recording Counter ...............81
USER button ................................................82
Setting the USER button ........................82
Using the USER button ..........................83
Functions of the USER button ...............84
Useful functions ........................................106
Color Bar Screen .................................106
ND filter ................................................107
Switching the screen indications/
mode information display .....................108
Using Operation Icons ..............................109
Using of jog dial ........................................110

Playback
Motion picture/Still picture playback ......113
Motion picture playback using
operation icon ......................................117
Useful functions ........................................118
Creating still picture from motion
picture ..................................................118
Repeat Playback ..................................119
Resuming the previous playback .........119
Playing back scenes or still pictures
by date .................................................119

Editing
Deleting scenes/still pictures ...................121
Protecting scenes/still pictures .............122
Copying between SD cards ......................123

-9-

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

10 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Linking to external devices

Display

Connecting Headphones, a Remote
Control or an External Monitor ................ 125
Headphones ........................................ 125
Remote control .................................... 125
External monitor .................................. 126
Setting the external output
resolution ............................................. 128
Connecting to a PC
(File transfer/nonlinear editing) ............... 132
Operating environment
(mass storage) ..................................... 132
Connecting to a PC ............................. 133
About the PC display ........................... 134
Copying/playing back with an external
media device ............................................. 136
Preparing for copying/playing back ..... 136
Copy once ........................................... 139
Copy selected files .............................. 139
Playing back the External Media ......... 140
Using an iPad as a Remote Control
(AG ROP application) ............................... 141
Before connection ................................ 142
Connecting this unit and an iPad ......... 146
Operations during AG ROP
application connection ......................... 150

Indications .................................................203
Messages ...................................................206
Warning Indications ..................................212

Menu
Using the Menu ......................................... 151
Scene file ............................................. 151
System mode ....................................... 160
User switch .......................................... 167
Switch setting ...................................... 168
Auto switch setting ............................... 175
Recording Setup .................................. 177
Audio Setup ......................................... 186
Output Setup ....................................... 188
Display setting ..................................... 191
Other Functions ................................... 196
Network Setup ..................................... 199
Maintenance ........................................ 200
Video Setup ......................................... 201
Picture Setup ....................................... 202
Copy .................................................... 202

Others
Troubleshooting ........................................215
About recovery .....................................219
About copyright ........................................220
Recording functions that cannot be
used simultaneously .................................222
Recording modes/approximate
recordable time .........................................223
Approximate number of recordable
pictures ......................................................225
Specification ..............................................226
For United Kingdom and Ireland customers

∫ Sales and Support Information
Customer Communications Centre
≥ For customers within the UK: 0344 844 3899
≥ For customers within lreland: 01 289 8333
≥ Monday–Friday 9:00 am – 5:00 pm
(Excluding public holidays).
≥ For further support on your product, please
visit our website:
www.panasonic.co.uk
Direct Sales at Panasonic UK
≥ Order accessory and consumable items for
your product with ease and confidence by
phoning our Customer Communications Centre
Monday–Friday 9:00 am – 5:00 pm
(Excluding public holidays).
≥ Or go on line through our Internet Accessory
ordering application at www.pas-europe.com.
≥ Most major credit and debit cards accepted.
≥ All enquiries transactions and distribution
facilities are provided directly by Panasonic UK.
≥ It couldn’t be simpler!
≥ Also available through our Internet is direct
shopping for a wide range of finished products.
Take a browse on our website for further details.

- 10 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

11 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Accessories
Check the accessories before using this unit.
Keep the accessories out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
Product numbers correct as of November 2016. These may be subject to change.
SYA0021

Battery pack
AG-VBR59

Microphone holder (l 22)
VYC1146

Battery charger
AG-BRD50*1

INPUT terminal cap
(2 caps)*2
VJF1468

AC adaptor
SAE0011

AC cable
(HC-X1E)
AK2CT2YY00095
BK2CQ2YY00117
(HC-X1GC)
AK2CT2YY00095
≥ In Saudi Arabia, always use
A.
BK2CQ2YY00117
CK2CJ2YY00052
Microphone holder
mounting screws (l 22)
VYC1144
12 mm length
(2 screws)

Eye cup (l 21)
SYA0048



Lens hood*3
SYK1585



*1


*2
*3

- 11 -

The AG-BRD50 is available for purchase
as an optional accessory package
containing a battery charger, AC adaptor,
and AC cable.
Individual battery chargers are sold under
the model number SAB0002. Contact your
dealer to purchase them.
The INPUT terminal caps are supplied
with the microphone holder.
The lens hood is attached to this unit at
the time of purchase.

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

12 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Optional accessories
Some optional accessories may not be available in some countries.
Product numbers correct as of November 2016. These may be subject to change.
Unidirectional microphone (AG-MC200G)
Battery pack (VW-VBD58/AG-VBR59/AG-VBR89/AG-VBR118)
Battery charger (AG-B23/AG-BRD50*)
LED video light (VW-LED1)
* The AG-BRD50 is available for purchase as an optional accessory package containing a battery
charger, AC adaptor, and AC cable.
Individual battery chargers are sold under the model number SAB0002. Contact your dealer to
purchase them.

- 12 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

13 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

What you can do with this unit
Recording to the SD card
It is possible to record motion pictures and still pictures to the SD card using a variety of recording
functions.
≥ This unit supports relay/simultaneous/background/dual codec recording using double card slots.

Linking to external devices
USB Device Mode
Transfer data (files) to perform nonlinear editing on another device (PC, etc.).
≥ This unit supports USB 3.0.





A
B
C
*1
*2

SD card*1
USB 3.0 (Device mode)*2
PC

SD cards are optional and not supplied with this unit.
A USB 3.0 cable is not supplied with this unit. Use a commercially-available double-shielded
USB 3.0 cable with a ferrite core.
If possible, we recommend using a cable with a length of 1.5 m or less.

- 13 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

14 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

USB Host Mode
If you connect an external media device, such as USB HDD or USB flash memory (commerciallyavailable) to this unit, you can copy motion pictures and still pictures recorded on this unit to the
external media device.
It can also play back the scenes and still pictures copied to the external media device.
≥ This unit supports USB 3.0.
Refer to the following support site for information about an external media device.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/e_cam
(This Site is English only)





A
B

USB 3.0 (Host mode)
External media device (commercially-available)

Connecting to an external monitor
Connect an external monitor to output images.





A
B
*1
*2

AV cable*1
HDMI cable*2

C

External monitor

Use a commercially-available AV cable
Use a commercially-available High Speed HDMI cable.
If possible, we recommend using a cable with a length of 3 m or less.

When connecting with an HDMI cable using an HDMI-to-DVI converter, etc., be sure to
connect the HDMI cable to the connector of this unit last.
Connecting the HDMI cable to the connector of this unit first may result in malfunction.

- 14 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

15 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Remote operations with an iPad
Attaching a wireless module that support this unit (l 142) to the USB HOST terminal of this unit
allows you to connect to a wireless LAN network. You can perform the following operations by
connecting this unit and an iPad on which the AG ROP application is installed:
≥ Checking the camera status
≥ Checking the thumbnail images of recorded scenes
≥ Playing back scenes recorded as sub recordings with [DUAL CODEC REC] set to [FHD 8Mbps]
≥ Controlling the camera remotely (recording control and Time Code/User Information operations)

- 15 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

16 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

Names and Functions of Main Parts
4

2
3
16

15

17
18
19

6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13

1

14

5

20
21
22
23
24
25

1
2
3
4
5
6

USB HOST terminal (l 136, 141)
USB DEVICE terminal (l 133)
HDMI OUT connector [HDMI] (l 126)
Handle
Lens hood release button (l 20)
Audio input terminal 1 (XLR 3 pin)
[AUDIO INPUT1] (l 22, 74)
7 Microphone holder attachment part
(l 22)
8 Lens hood (l 20)
9 Status indicator (l 31)
10 Power switch (l 31)
11 Recording start/stop button (l 42)
12 Cable holder
≥ Secures an HDMI cable.
13 Inlet (cooling fan) (l 41)
14 DC input terminal [DC IN] (l 28)
≥ Do not use any other AC adaptors except the
supplied one.

15 Camera remote terminal [CAM
REMOTE] (l 125)
≥ FOCUS IRIS terminal (3.5 mm diameter mini
jack)
≥ ZOOM S/S terminal (2.5 mm diameter super
mini jack)
16 Headphone terminal [ ] (l 112, 125)
17 VIDEO OUT terminal (l 126)
18 AUDIO OUT CH1 terminal (l 126)
19 AUDIO OUT CH2 terminal (l 126)
20 Microphone cable clamper (l 22)
21 Speaker
22 Shoulder strap fixture
23 Inlet (cooling fan) (l 41)
24 Hand strap (l 21)
25 Audio input terminal 2 (XLR 3 pin)
[AUDIO INPUT2] (l 22, 74)

- 16 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

17 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

26

27

31
32
33
34

28
29
30

40 41

35
36

37

38 39

42 43

26 Tripod receptacle
≥ There are tripod mounting holes that are
compatible with 1/4-20UNC and 3/8-16UNC
screws. Use the size that matches the
diameter of the tripod’s fixing screw.
≥ Attaching a tripod with a screw length of
5.5 mm or more may damage the unit.
27 Eyepiece corrector lever (l 36)
28 ND filter switch [ND FILTER] (l 107)
29 Focus Auto/Manual/¶ switch
[FOCUS A/M/¶] (l 52)
30 Iris button [IRIS] (l 67)
31 FOCUS ASSIST button (l 56)
32 User 1 button [USER1] (l 83)
33 User 2 button [USER2] (l 83)
34 User 3 button [USER3] (l 83)
35 Display/Mode check button [DISP/
MODE CHK] (l 83, 108)

44 45 46 47
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49

- 17 -

48 49

PUSH AUTO button (l 52)
Focus ring (l 52)
Zoom ring (l 48)
Iris ring (l 67)
User 6 button [O.I.S.] (l 50, 83)
User 7 button [LCD/EVF] (l 32, 83)
Gain button [GAIN] (l 69)
White Balance button [WHITE BAL]
(l 63)
Jog dial [SEL/PUSH SET] (l 63, 69, 71,
110, 115)
Menu button [MENU] (l 40)
Shutter speed button [SHUTTER] (l 71)
Auto/Manual switch [AUTO/MANU]
(l 44)
User 4 button [WFM] (l 83, 95)
User 5 button [ZEBRA] (l 83, 97)

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

50

51 52

18 ページ

2016年11月28日

58 59 60 61 62

月曜日

午前11時40分

63 64 65

66

53 54

67
68

55 56 57
69
70
71
72
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62

SD Card slot cover (l 30)
Access lamp (card 1) (l 30)
Card slot 1 (l 30)
Access lamp (card 2) (l 30)
Card slot 2 (l 30)
INPUT1 / INPUT2 switches (l 74)
CH1 SELECT/CH2 SELECT switches
(l 74)
AUDIO LEVEL CH1/AUDIO LEVEL CH2
knobs (l 76)
LCD monitor extract part (l 33)
LCD monitor (Touch screen) (l 34)
Lens cover open/close lever (l 20)
Recording lamp (Rear) (l 196)
Shoulder strap fixture

63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74

- 18 -

73
74

Eye cup mount (l 21)
Eye sensor (l 37)
Viewfinder (l 36)
Eye cup (l 21)
Battery release button [PUSH] (l 25)
Battery holder (l 25)
Built-in microphone
Recording lamp (Front) (l 196)
Lens cover (l 20)
Exhaust opening (cooling fan) (l 41)
Lens (LEICA DICOMAR)
User 9 button [AWB] (l 63, 83)

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

19 ページ

2016年11月28日

75 76

月曜日

午前11時40分

77 78 79 80

81 82 83 84

85

75 Accessory shoe
76 Sub zoom lever (l 48, 174)
≥ This lever functions in the same manner as
the zoom lever.
≥ The zoom speed is controlled with this lever
in a way different from the way it is controlled
with the zoom lever. (l 49)
77 Zoom lever [T/W] (l 48) (In Recording
Mode)
Volume lever [rVOLs] (l 115)/
Thumbnail display switch [
/
]
(l 115) (In Playback Mode)
78 User 8 button [REC CHECK] (l 83, 88)
79 Focal plane index [ ]
≥ Indicates the focal plane of the MOS sensor.

80 Handle mounting hole
(Size of the mounting hole)
j 1/4-20UNCk2
j 3/8-16UNCk2
81 Thumbnail button [THUMBNAIL] (l 31)
82 Counter button [COUNTER] (l 78)
83 Counter reset button [RESET] (l 80)
84 Color Bar Screen button [BARS] (l 106)
85 Sub recording start/stop button (l 174)
≥ This button functions in the same manner as
the recording start/stop button.

- 19 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

20 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Attaching/detaching the lens hood
(How to detach the lens hood)

While pressing and holding the lens hood release button, rotate the lens hood in
the direction of the arrow to detach it.
A



Lens hood release button

(How to attach the lens hood)




B

1

Mounting mark

Fit the lens hood into this unit.

≥ Align the mounting mark on the lens hood with the mounting mark on this unit.

2

Rotate the lens hood in the direction of the arrow.

≥ Rotate until it clicks into place.

Opening/closing the lens cover
You can open/close the lens cover by sliding the lens cover open/close lever.
≥ When this unit is not in use, close the lens cover to protect the lens.

OPEN

CLOSE

≥ Do not press the lens cover hard. This may damage the lens or the lens cover.
≥ Depending on the various filters or the MC protector attached to the front side of this unit's lens,
you may not be able to open/close the lens cover or attach the lens hood.

- 20 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

21 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Adjust the length of the hand strap so that it fits your hand.
Adjust the hand strap according to the size of your hand.
≥ If you find it difficult to fasten the buckle B, move the pad A forward, and fasten the buckle B
again.
1
2



Open the buckle.
Pull the end of the belt.






∫ Attaching the eye cup
1
2

Align the mounting mark on the eye cup mount with the corresponding mark on
the eyecup.
Attach the eye cup so that the notch on the eye cup mount is aligned with the
protrusion inside the eye cup.







A
B
C



≥ Push the eye cup in until it reaches the mounting mark. (D)

- 21 -

Mounting marks
Notch
Protrusion

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

22 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Attaching the front microphone
≥ The microphone holder is set up so that a 21 mm external microphone (AG-MC200G: optional)
can be attached. Check in advance whether the microphone you wish to use can be attached.

1

Attach the microphone holder to the microphone holder attachment part.

≥ Attach by using a commercially available screw driver.
≥ When attaching the microphone holder, be sure to tighten the screws firmly even though you
might hear a squeaking sound.



A
B
C



Microphone holder attachment part
Microphone holder
Microphone holder mounting screws


2

Attach an external microphone (optional) to the
microphone holder, and tighten the microphone
holder screw.
Connect the external microphone to the AUDIO
INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin).

3

≥ When wiring the microphone cable, use the cable clamper of
this unit.
≥ Keep the microphone holder screw, INPUT terminal cap out of
reach of children to prevent swallowing.
D
E
F
G








AUDIO INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin)
Microphone cable clamper
Microphone holder screw
External microphone (optional)

∫ Attaching the INPUT terminal cap
Attach the INPUT terminal cap while the AUDIO INPUT1, 2 terminals (XLR 3 pin) are not used.

A

INPUT terminal cap



- 22 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

23 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

Power supply
∫ About batteries that you can use with this unit (as of November
2016)
The battery that can be used with this unit is VW-VBD58/AG-VBR59/AG-VBR89/AG-VBR118.
≥ The AG-VBR59/AG-VBR89/AG-VBR118 supports quick charging.
It has been found that counterfeit battery packs which look very similar to the genuine
product are made available to purchase in some markets. Some of these battery packs
are not adequately protected with internal protection to meet the requirements of
appropriate safety standards. There is a possibility that these battery packs may lead to
fire or explosion. Please be advised that we are not liable for any accident or failure
occurring as a result of use of a counterfeit battery pack. To ensure that safe products are
used we would recommend that a genuine Panasonic battery pack is used.

Charging the battery
When this unit is purchased, the battery is not charged. Charge the battery fully before
using this unit for the first time.
Important:
≥ Do not use the AC cable with any other equipment as it is designed only for this unit. Also,
do not use the AC cable from other equipment with this unit.
≥ It is recommended to charge the battery in a temperature between 10 oC and 30 oC. (The
battery temperature should also be the same.)

∫ About the Battery Charger
This unit can charge two battery packs simultaneously and supports quickcharging batteries.
CHARGE indicators [CHARGE 1/CHARGE 2]
Indicate the charge status as follows.



Indicator


A
B

DC IN 12 V connector
CHARGE indicators
[CHARGE 1/CHARGE 2]

Charge status

Lit green

Quick charging is in
progress. (Battery
charging time: l 26)

Lit orange

Normal charging is in
progress.

Blinking orange

Charging has stopped due
to an error. (l 6)

Off

Charging is complete, or a
battery pack is not
inserted.

DC IN 12 V connector [
]
Connects to the DC plug of the AC adaptor.

- 23 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

24 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Charging the battery

1
2



Connect the AC mains lead to the
AC adaptor.

≥ Perform step 2 first, and then step 3. Insert
the AC mains lead all the way in until it stops.

3



Connect the DC plug of the AC
adaptor to the DC IN 12 V
connector of battery charger.

Insert the battery into the battery
charger.

≥ Slide the battery horizontally into the battery
charger along the “
” mark.
≥ The corresponding CHARGE indicator lights
and charging starts.
≥ The CHARGE indicator turns off when
charging is complete. Slide the battery to
remove it.




≥
≥
≥
≥
≥
≥

≥

≥

We recommend using Panasonic batteries (l 26).
If you use other batteries, we cannot guarantee the quality of this product.
Do not heat or expose to flame.
Do not leave the battery(ies) in a car exposed to direct sunlight for a long period of time with
doors and windows closed.
After the battery is inserted, it may take some time for it to be detected and the CHARGE indicator
to light. If the CHARGE indicator does not light after 10 seconds, insert the battery again.
If two batteries that support quick charging are inserted, priority will be given to the battery
inserted in the CHARGE 1 slot, and the battery inserted in the CHARGE 2 slot will be charged in
normal-charge mode. When charging on the CHARGE 1 slot progresses to a certain point,
charging on the CHARGE 2 slot will automatically switch to quick-charge mode.
In addition, the charge indicator (LED lamps) on the battery inserted in the CHARGE 2 slot may
turn off depending on the charge status of the battery.
The battery charger determines the state of the battery first to perform optimal charging. It will, as
a result, take about 20 seconds for charging to start after the CHARGE indicator on the battery
charger lights. When charging starts, the charge indicator (LED lamps) on a battery that supports
quick charging will flash. If you remove and reinsert a battery or swap batteries while charging is
in progress on both the CHARGE 1 and CHARGE 2 slots, charging for both batteries will stop
temporarily, and the battery charger will determine the state of the batteries again before
restarting. Therefore, it will take about 20 seconds to restart charging.
Insert the battery that you want charged first in the CHARGE 1 slot.

- 24 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

25 ページ

2016年11月28日

Inserting/removing the battery
Install the battery by inserting it in the
direction shown in the figure.
≥ Insert the battery until it clicks and locks.

Removing the battery
Make sure that the power switch is set to OFF and the
status indicator is turned off, and then remove by
holding onto it taking care not to drop. (l 31)
While pressing the battery release button, remove
the battery.

- 25 -

月曜日

午前11時40分

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

26 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Charging and recording time
Charging/Recording time

Battery model
number

Voltage/Capacity
(minimum)

Charging
time

Supplied battery/
AG-VBR59
(optional)

7.28 V/5900 mAh

3 h 20 min

AG-VBR89
(optional)

7.28 V/8850 mAh

4h

AG-VBR118
(optional)
VW-VBD58
(optional)

7.28 V/11800 mAh
7.2 V/5800 mAh

4 h 40 min
5 h 20 min

System
Frequency setting
(l 160)

Continuously
recordable time

59.94 Hz

3 h 25 min

50.00 Hz

3 h 35 min

59.94 Hz

5 h 10 min

50.00 Hz

5 h 30 min

59.94 Hz

6 h 50 min

50.00 Hz

7 h 15 min

59.94 Hz

3 h 20 min

50.00 Hz

3 h 35 min

≥ The above charging times apply when the supplied battery charger is used.
≥ The times given apply when the ambient operating temperature is 25 oC and the relative
operating humidity is 60%. Charging time may be longer at other temperatures and humidity
levels.
≥ The continuous recordable time given applies under the conditions below. The time becomes
shorter under other conditions.
j The LCD monitor is open
j A cable is not inserted to the external output terminal
≥ “h” is an abbreviation for hour, “min” for minute and “s” for second.
≥ These times are approximations.
≥ The indicated charging time is for when the battery has been discharged completely.
Charging time and recordable time vary depending on the usage conditions such as high/
low temperature.
≥ The batteries heat up after use or charging. This is not a malfunction.
≥ The optional battery charger AG-B23 (DE-A88) can be used to charge the battery but charging
will take longer.

- 26 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

27 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Checking the remaining power of the battery
You can check the remaining power of the battery by looking at the battery capacity indication
displayed on this unit's screen or by looking at the supplied battery AG-VBR59.

∫ Checking the remaining power using this unit
Battery capacity indication
≥ The display changes as the battery capacity reduces.
If the battery discharges, then
will flash red.

#

#

#

#

≥ Depending on the menu setting, the battery capacity indication is not displayed (l 194)
[DISP SETUP] # [CARD & BATTERY]

∫ Checking the remaining power using the battery
If you press the CHECK button when charging is not in progress, the indicator (LED lamps) will light
in green so that you can check the remaining power of the battery.

パ

ヒパパ テ



ヤラユヤレ


A CHECK button
B Indicator
≥ The remaining power of the battery is an approximate guide.
≥ When the LED lamp does not light up even if you press the CHECK button, the battery is
exhausted. Charge the battery.

How to read the indicator
An approximate guide of the charging progress is indicated by the flashing position of the LED
lamps when charging is in progress. The LED lamps turn off when charging is complete.
:Flashing in green/

:Lit in green/

:Off

LED lamp status
When checking the
remaining power

During charging

Remaining power of the battery /
Charging progress
0% to 25%
25% to 50%
50% to 75%
75% to 100%

≥ The display of the indicator is an approximate guide. When the battery pack is connected to the
video camera or the charger, refer to the remaining power display of the connected device. The
display of the connected device may differ from that of the battery pack’s indicator.

- 27 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

28 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Connecting to the AC outlet
The unit is in the standby condition when the AC adaptor is connected. The primary circuit is always
“live” as long as the AC adaptor is connected to an electrical outlet.
Important:
≥ Use the supplied AC adaptor. Do not use the AC adaptor of another device.
≥ Do not use the AC cable with any other equipment as it is designed only for this unit. Also,
do not use the AC cable from other equipment with this unit.

1
2




Connect the AC cable to the AC
adaptor and the AC outlet.
Connect the AC adaptor to the DC
input terminal [DC IN].

≥ Make sure to set the power switch to OFF and
the status indicator is turned off when
disconnecting the AC adaptor. (l 31)



≥ Insert the plugs as far as they will go.

≥ Even when you use the AC adaptor for recording images, keep the battery connected. This
allows you to continue the recording even if a power failure occurs or the AC adaptor is
unplugged from the AC outlet by accident.
≥ This unit consumes a small amount of power even when turned off. When leaving the product
unused for a long time, disconnect the AC adaptor from the AC outlet for power saving.

- 28 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

29 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

Preparation of SD cards
The unit can record motion pictures or still pictures to an SD card.

Cards that you can use with this unit
≥ The cards that you can use are correct as of November 2016.
≥ We recommend that you use a Panasonic Memory Card.
Card type

Capacity

SDHC Memory Card
SDXC Memory Card

4 GB to 32 GB
48 GB to 128 GB

≥ We do not guarantee the operation of SD cards other than the ones above.
≥ 4 GB or more Memory Cards that do not have the SDHC logo or 48 GB or more Memory Cards
that do not have the SDXC logo are not based on SD Memory Card Specifications.
≥ This unit is compatible with UHS-I UHS Speed Class3 standard SDHC/SDXC Memory Cards.
≥ When the write-protect switch A on SD card is locked, no recording,
deletion or editing will be possible on the card.
≥ Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.

64
∫ About the Speed Class ratings for recording motion pictures
≥ Depending on [REC MODE] (l 160) and [REC FORMAT] (l 161), the required card differs.
Use a card that meets the following ratings of the SD Speed Class or UHS Speed Class.
Use of a non-compatible card may cause recording to stop suddenly.
≥ SD Speed Class and UHS Speed Class are the speed standards regarding continuous writing. To
check the class, see the labelled side, etc. of the card.
Recording modes

Recording function
or
Recording format

Speed Class ratings

VFR Mode,
Super Slow
Recording,
100 Mbps or more

UHS Speed Class3*

MOV/MP4

Label examples

UHS Speed Class1 or
more
50 Mbps
Class10 or more

AVCHD

All

Class4 or more

* If you select [UHD 2160/59.94p 150M] or [UHD 2160/50.00p 150M], you will need an SDXC
Memory Card with a capacity of at least 64 GB that supports UHS Speed Class3.

- 29 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

30 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Inserting/removing an SD card
When using an SD card for the first time, it is necessary to format the SD card. (l 42) When the
SD card is formatted, all of the recorded data is deleted. Once the data is deleted, it cannot be
restored.
Caution:
Check that the access lamp has gone off.

Access lamp A
≥ When this unit is accessing the SD card,
the access lamp lights up.

1

Open the SD card slot cover and
insert (remove) the SD card into
(from) the card slot B.

≥ One SD card can be inserted into each of the
card slot 1 and the card slot 2.
≥ Face the terminal side C in the direction
shown in the illustration and press it straight
in as far as it will go.
≥ Press the center of the SD card and then pull
it straight out.







≥ Do not touch the terminals on the back of the
SD card.
≥ Do not apply strong shocks, bend, or drop the
SD card.
≥ Electrical noise, static electricity or the failure
of this unit or the SD card may damage or
erase the data stored on the SD card.
≥ When the card access lamp is lit, do not:
j Remove the SD card
j Turn the unit off
j Insert and remove the USB Cable
j Expose the unit to vibrations or shock
Performing the above while the lamp is on
may result in damage to data/SD card or this
unit.
≥ Do not expose the terminals of the SD card to
water, dirt or dust.

2

Securely close the SD card slot
cover.

≥ Do not place SD cards in the following areas:
j In direct sunlight
j In very dusty or humid areas
j Near a heater
j Locations susceptible to significant
difference in temperature (condensation
can occur.)
j Where static electricity or electromagnetic
waves occur
≥ To protect SD cards, return them to their
cases when you are not using them.
≥ About disposing of or giving away the SD
card. (l 6)

- 30 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

31 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

Turning the unit on/off
Set the power switch to ON while pressing the lock release button B to turn on
the unit.



OFF

To turn off the unit
Set the power switch to OFF while
pressing the lock release button.
The status indicator goes off.

ON


A

The status indicator lights on.

≥ To turn on the unit again after the [ECONOMY (BATT)] or [ECONOMY (AC)] is activated, set the
power switch to OFF once, and then to ON again. (l 197)
Preparation

Selecting a mode
Press the THUMBNAIL button to change the mode to Recording Mode or
Playback Mode.
A THUMBNAIL button



Recording Mode (l 42)

The recording screen is displayed. You can record motion
pictures.

Playback Mode (l 113)

The thumbnail screen for playback is displayed. You can play
back motion pictures and still pictures.

≥ When you turn on this unit, it starts up in Recording Mode.
≥ If you press the recording start/stop button or sub recording start/stop button in Playback Mode,
the mode will be switched to Recording Mode and recording will start.

- 31 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

32 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

Using the LCD monitor/Viewfinder
Setting how to turn on/off the LCD monitor and
Viewfinder
Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] # desired setting

[AUTO]:

The LCD monitor is turned on when the LCD monitor is extracted. When you move
your eye closer to the eye cup of the viewfinder, the LCD monitor is turned off, and
the viewfinder is turned on.

[LCD]:

The LCD monitor is turned on when the LCD monitor is extracted. The viewfinder is
not turned on.

∫ To change the setting with a USER button
You can change how to turn on/off the LCD monitor and Viewfinder by registering [LCD/EVF
OUTPUT] to a USER button.
≥ This function is registered to the USER7 button by default.
≥ Please refer to page 82 for details about setting the USER button.

When the recording screen is displayed, press the USER button to which [LCD/
EVF OUTPUT] is registered.
≥ Switches the setting each time the button is pressed.
[AUTO] ←
→ [LCD]
≥ The setting is also applied to the [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] menu setting.
≥ If you wear certain types of glasses or hold the camera in certain ways, or when the eyepiece
area is exposed to bright light, the eye sensor may not work correctly.
≥ If the eye sensor does not work correctly, adjust the [EYE SENSOR] setting. (l 37)
≥ You can turn on/off the viewfinder by registering [EVF ON/OFF] to a USER button.

- 32 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

33 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using the LCD monitor

1

Extract the LCD monitor in the
direction as indicated in the figure.

≥ Hold the LCD monitor extract part A, and
extract the LCD monitor until it clicks into
position.

2



Rotate to the position that is easy
to view.

To retract the LCD monitor
Retract as shown in the figure with the LCD facing
downward.

Range of rotation of the LCD monitor
≥ It can rotate up to 270o towards the lens.

270°

- 33 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

34 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

How to use the touch screen
You can operate by directly touching the LCD monitor (touch screen) with your finger.

∫ Touch
Touch and release the touch screen to select icon or
picture.
≥ Touch the center of the icon.
≥ Touching the touch screen will not operate while you
are touching another part of the touch screen.

∫ Slide while touching
Move your finger while pressing on the touch screen.

∫ About the operation icons
/
/
/
:
Touch when changing a page or performing settings.

≥ Do not touch the LCD monitor with hard pointed tips, such as ball point pens.

- 34 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

35 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

LCD monitor adjustment
≥ These settings will not affect the images actually recorded.

[POWER LCD]
This makes it easier to view the LCD monitor in bright places including outdoors.

Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # [POWER LCD] #

[+1] (Makes brighter)/[0] (Normal)/[-1] (Makes less bright)

≥ When the AC adaptor is in use, [POWER LCD] is set to [+1] automatically.
≥ [0] is selected when:
j [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)
≥ This item is not available while the LCD monitor is turned off.

[LCD SET]
It adjusts brightness and color density on the LCD monitor.

1

Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

2

3

: [DISP SETUP] # [LCD SET]

Touch the desired setting item.
[COLOUR]:

Color level of the LCD monitor

[BRIGHTNESS]:

Brightness of the LCD monitor

[CONTRAST]:

Contrast of the LCD monitor

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s16 and r16.

4

Touch [RETURN].

≥ Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.
≥ This item is not available while the LCD monitor is turned off.

- 35 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

36 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Viewfinder adjustment
≥ These settings will not affect the images actually recorded.

Adjusting the field of view
It adjusts the field of view to show the image on the viewfinder clearly.

1

Adjust the viewfinder to suit your vision so
that you can see the display images clearly.

≥ Be careful not to trap your fingers when moving the
viewfinder.
≥ The viewfinder can be lifted vertically up to
approximately 90o.
≥ Bring your eye close to the viewfinder to turn it on.

2



Adjust the focus by operating the eyepiece
corrector lever.

A

Eyepiece corrector lever

[EVF SETTING]
It adjusts brightness and color density of the viewfinder.
≥ Use the jog dial to change the settings. (l 110)

1

Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

2

: [DISP SETUP] # [EVF SETTING] # desired setting

[COLOUR]:

Color level of the viewfinder

[BRIGHTNESS]:

Brightness of the viewfinder

[CONTRAST]:

Contrast of the viewfinder

Rotate the jog dial to move the cursor to the
value display A.

≥ Push the jog dial to select the value display.

3

Rotate the jog dial to adjust the setting.

≥ Pushing the jog dial will set the value you have selected.
≥ You can select a value between s16 and r16.

4

Select [RETURN].

≥ Select [EXIT].
≥ This item is not available while the viewfinder is turned off.
≥ When [COLOUR] is set to s16, images are displayed in black and white.

- 36 -



HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

37 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[EVF COLOUR]
The recording images or playback images on the viewfinder can be selected between color/black
and white.

Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # [EVF COLOUR]# [ON] or [OFF]

[ON]:

Displayed in color

[OFF]:

Displayed in black and white

≥ If you adjust the [COLOUR] setting in [EVF SETTING], [EVF COLOUR] will be set to [ON].

[EYE SENSOR]
It adjusts sensitivity of eye sensor.

1

Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

2

: [DISP SETUP] # [EYE SENSOR]

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s4 and r4.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ When the [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] is set to [LCD], this item cannot be set. (l 32)

Recording yourself
≥ Change the mode to Recording Mode. (l 31)
Rotate the LCD monitor towards the lens side.
≥ Displaying during the recording yourself can be
switched by setting [SELF SHOOT]. (l 195)

≥ Only some indications will appear on the screen when the [SELF SHOOT] is set to [MIRROR].
When
appears, return the direction of the LCD monitor to normal position and check the
warning/alarm indication. (l 206)
≥ When the viewfinder is turned up, the LCD monitor is turned off.

- 37 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

38 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Preparation

Setting date and time
When this unit is turned on, the message [SET TIME ZONE AND DATE/TIME] may appear.
To make these settings, select [YES], and follow the instructions from Step 2-3 of the time zone
setting procedure.

Time zone
Time difference from the Greenwich Mean Time can be set.

1

Select the menu. (l 40)
MENU

2
3

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [TIME ZONE]

Touch
/
and set the region to record.
Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ If the [CLOCK SET] screen appears, perform [CLOCK SET].
≥ When the time zone setting is changed, the date/time setting of the unit also changes
automatically.

Clock setting

1

Select the menu. (l 40)

MENU

2

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [CLOCK SET]

Touch the date or time to be set, then set the
desired value using
/
.

≥ The year can be set between 2000 and 2039.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ The date and time function is driven by a built-in lithium battery.
≥ If the time display becomes [- -], the built-in lithium battery needs to be charged. To recharge the
built-in lithium battery, connect the AC adaptor or attach a charged battery to this unit. Leave the
unit as it is for approx. 24 hours and the battery will maintain the date and time for approx.
6 months. (The battery is still being recharged even if the unit is off.)
≥ The way that time is displayed can be changed in the menu settings. (l 193)
[DISP SETUP] # [DATE/TIME] or [DATE FORMAT]

- 38 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

39 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Time zone table
Time
difference
0:00

Time
difference

Region

Region

London, Casablanca

r3:30

Tehran

Azores

r4:00

Dubai, Abu Dhabi

s2:00

Fernando de Noronha

r4:30

s3:00

Rio de Janeiro, Sao Paulo,
Buenos Aires

s1:00

s3:30
s4:00

r5:00

Newfoundland
Manaus, La Paz

Kabul
Islamabad, Karachi, Male

r5:30

Delhi, Kolkata, Mumbai, Chennai,
Colombo

r5:45

Kathmandu

s4:30

Caracas

r6:00

Dhaka

s5:00

Toronto, New York, Miami, Lima

r6:30

Yangon

Chicago, Houston, Mexico City

r7:00

Bangkok, Jakarta

r8:00

Beijing, Hong Kong, Kuala
Lumpur, Singapore

s6:00
s7:00

Denver, Phoenix

s8:00

Vancouver, Seattle, Los Angeles

r9:00

Seoul, Tokyo

s9:00

Alaska, Anchorage

r9:30

Adelaide

s10:00

Hawaii, Honolulu, Tahiti

r10:00

Guam, Sydney

s11:00

Midway Islands

r11:00

Solomon Islands, New Caledonia

r1:00

Berlin, Paris, Rome, Madrid

r12:00

Fiji, Auckland, Wellington

r2:00

Helsinki, Athens, Cairo,
Johannesburg

r12:45

r3:00

Moscow, Kuwait, Riyadh, Nairobi

- 39 -

Chatham Islands

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

40 ページ

2016年11月28日

Preparation

Using the menu screen
≥ You can also select menu items by operating the jog dial. (l 110)

MENU

1
2

3

Press the MENU button

MENU

.

Touch the top menu A.

Touch the submenu B.

≥ Next (Previous) page can be displayed by touching
/
.

4
5

Touch the desired item to enter the setting.
Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu setting.

- 40 -

月曜日

午前11時40分

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

41 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Before recording
When recording, make sure your footing is stable and there is no danger of colliding with another person or object.
Hold the eye cup of the viewfinder as close as possible to your eye.
Adjust the angle of the LCD monitor according to the position in which the unit is held.
When you are outdoors, record pictures with the sunlight behind you. If the subject is backlit, it will
become dark in the recording.
≥ Keep your arms near your body and separate your legs for better balance.
≥ For stable images, it is recommended to use a tripod whenever possible.
≥ Do not block the cooling fan inlet or the exhaust opening with your hand or other objects.
≥
≥
≥
≥

Recording

Selecting a media to record
You can specify the card slot to which motion pictures are to be recorded.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [RECORD SETUP] # [MEDIA SELECT] # [SD CARD 1]/[SD CARD 2]

≥ In the following situation, if you start recording with normal settings or start recording when
[2 SLOTS FUNC.] (l 177) is set to [RELAY REC], the card slot used for motion picture recording
will be switched automatically:
j An SD card is not inserted to the card slot selected in [MEDIA SELECT], or the SD card in the
selected card slot is full when there is another SD card in the other slot.
≥ You can also change the card slot used for motion picture recording by pressing the USER button to which
[SLOT SEL] is registered or touching the applicable USER button icon while recording is paused. (l 82)

- 41 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

42 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Formatting media
If you use the SD cards for the first time for recording with this unit, format the cards.
Please be aware that if a medium is formatted, then all the data recorded on the medium will be
erased and cannot be restored. Back up important data on a PC etc. (l 132)
≥ When using two SD cards, format both SD cards.

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [FORMAT MEDIA]

Touch [SD CARD 1] or [SD CARD 2].

≥ When formatting is complete, touch [EXIT] to exit the message screen.
≥ Do not turn this unit off or remove the SD card, while formatting. Do not expose the unit to
vibrations or shock.
Use this unit to format media.
Do not format an SD card using any other equipment such as a PC. Otherwise it may not
be possible to use the card on this unit.
Recording

Recording motion picture
≥ Before turning on this unit, open the lens cover. (l 20)

1



Change the mode to
Recording Mode. (l 31)

REC

≥ Extract the LCD monitor.

2



Press the recording start/
stop button B to start
recording.

OFF

ON

≥ Recording will stop when you press
the recording start/stop button again.

A

When you begin recording, REC (red) is
displayed.

- 42 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

43 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Screen indications in the Recording Mode
TC 00:00:00:00
R 1h20m MAIN
R 1h20m
150M
50.00p

TC 00:00:00:00
/
(White)

Counter display (l 78)
Card slot number

R 1h20m

Approximate remaining recordable time
≥ When the remaining time is less than 1 minute, R 0h00m flashes red.
Card slot selected for motion picture recording (l 41)*

MAIN

Recording format (l 161)
150M

Bit rate (l 161)
Recording mode (l 160)

50.00p
Frame rate (l 161)
* Displayed only during normal recording.
≥ To change the recording method, change [REC MODE] or [REC FORMAT]. (l 160, 161)
≥ The images recorded between pressing the recording start/stop button to start recording and
pressing it again to pause recording become one scene.
≥ When the file size of a recorded scene exceeds one of the following sizes or the recording time
exceeds one of the following lengths of time, the scene will be divided automatically. (Recording
continues.)
AVCHD scene

Approximately 4 GB

MOV/MP4 scene (when using an SDHC Memory Card)

Approximately
4 GB or 30 minutes

MOV/MP4 scene (when using an SDXC Memory Card)

Approximately
96 GB or 3 hours

≥ (Maximum recordable scenes of a single SD card)
Recording mode

MOV/MP4

AVCHD

Recordable scenes

Approx. 89100

Approx. 3900

Different dates (l 119)

Approx. 900

Approx. 900

≥ When the SD card contains scenes recorded with [REC MODE] set to [MOV]/[MP4] and still
pictures, the maximum recordable scenes and the maximum recordable scenes on each date will
be smaller than those in the table above.
≥ Number of scenes that can be recorded will be less than above in following cases:
j If you change [REC FORMAT]
j When [2 SLOTS FUNC.] is set to [SIMULTANEOUS] or [DUAL CODEC] (l 177)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
≥ Please refer to page 223 about approximate recordable time.

- 43 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

44 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Switching between Auto and Manual
Mode
MANU

AUTO/MANU switch
Slide the switch to change Auto Mode/Manual
Mode.
≥

is displayed in the Auto Mode.

∫ Auto Mode
In Auto Mode, this unit operates according to the [AUTO SW] menu settings.
≥ When the following settings are automatically adjusted in Auto Mode, the corresponding Manual
Mode settings are canceled:
j Focus (l 52)
j Iris (l 67)

j GAIN (l 69)
j Shutter speed (l 71)

∫ To enable/disable auto switch functions
You can enable/disable functions that are automatically adjusted in Auto Mode.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [AUTO SW] # desired setting
Menu item

Setting
[ON]:

Activates Auto Iris in Auto Mode.

[A.IRIS]

[OFF]:

Activates Auto Iris as a manual mode. Use the IRIS button to
switch between Auto Iris Mode and Manual Iris Mode.

[ON]:

Activates Auto Gain in Auto Mode.

[AGC]

[OFF]:

Activates Auto Gain as a manual mode. The gain is adjusted
according to the settings assigned to the GAIN button.

[ON]:

Activates Auto Shutter in Auto Mode.

[OFF]:

Activates Auto Shutter as a manual mode. Press the SHUTTER
button to switch between Auto Shutter Mode and Manual
Shutter Mode.

[ON]:

Activates Auto Tracking White Balance in Auto Mode.

[OFF]:

Activates Auto Tracking White Balance as a manual mode.
White Balance is adjusted according to the settings of the
WHITE BAL button and the USER button to which [AWB] is
registered. (l 63)

[AUTO SHUTTER]

[ATW]

- 44 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

45 ページ

2016年11月28日

Menu item
[AF]

月曜日

午前11時40分

Setting
[ON]:

Activates Auto Focus in Auto Mode.

[OFF]:

Activates Auto Focus as a manual mode. Focus is adjusted
according to the functions of the FOCUS A/M/¶ switch.

Automatic Tracking White Balance
The Auto Tracking White (ATW) Balance function of this unit automatically adjusts the White
Balance according to the lighting condition.
If Auto Tracking White Balance does not work correctly, switch to Manual Mode first, and then adjust
the White Balance. (l 63)

Auto Focus
The unit focuses automatically.
≥ Auto Focus does not work correctly in the following situations. Record pictures in the Manual
Focus Mode. (l 52)
j Recording distant and close-up objects at the same time
j Recording a subject behind dirty or dusty window
j Recording a subject that is surrounded by objects with glossy surfaces or by highly reflective
objects

∫ Controls that are disabled in Auto Mode
Certain controls of this unit may be disabled in Auto Mode. Controls to be disabled vary by the
[AUTO SW] menu settings.
Conditions that disable controls

Controls that are disabled in Auto Mode

[A.IRIS] is set to [ON].

Iris Ring, IRIS button

[AGC] is set to [ON].

GAIN button, the USER button to which [SUPER GAIN]
is registered

[AUTO SHUTTER] is set to [ON].

SHUTTER button

[ATW] is set to [ON].

WHITE BAL button

[AF] is set to [ON].

Focus ring, FOCUS ASSIST button, FOCUS A/M/¶
switch, PUSH AUTO button, the USER button to which
[FOCUS ASSIST 1], [FOCUS ASSIST 2], [PUSH AUTO]
or [FOCUS TRANS] is registered

- 45 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

46 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Adjusting the Picture Quality
You can set the picture quality of images to be recorded in the main menu # [SCENE FILE].

Detail function
This function thickens or weakens the outlines of images. It effectively softens or sharpens images,
but in some cases, the whole image may become rough due to emphasized noise and edges. To
avoid such problems, it is necessary not to add this effect on parts where emphasizing is not
needed and keep the details of the parts.

∫ Menu item
[MASTER DETAIL]:
[DETAIL CORING]:
[SKIN TONE DTL]:
[V DETAIL LEVEL]:

Adjusts the degree of overall outline correction in images. (l 153)
Adjusts the detail noise removal level. (l 153)
Makes skin colors appear softer for a more attractive appearance. (l 153)
Adjusts the degree of vertical outline correction in images. (l 153)

Skin tone function
This function makes human skin look smoother in images.

∫ Menu item
[SKIN TONE DTL] (l 153)

RB gain control function
When the White Balance mode is set to [Ach] or [Bch], this function enhances or reduces the
intensity of red and blue. It works in combination with Auto White Balance.
≥ It does not work when the White Balance mode is set to [ATW], [P3200K], [P5600K], or [VAR].

∫ Menu item
[RB GAIN CONTROL SETTING] (l 154)

Chroma setting function
This function sets color saturation and phase. It applies effects on whole images. It cannot be set to
individual color hue.

∫ Menu item
[CHROMA LEVEL]:
[CHROMA PHASE]:

Adjusts the color density. (l 155)
Adjusts the color balance. (l 155)

- 46 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

47 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Color correction function
This function sets color saturation and phase. It applies individual effect on 16 phases in an image.
It can be set to individual color hue.

∫ Menu item
[COLOR CORRECTION SETTING] (l 156)

Black control function
This function sets the black level that is to be the reference of luminance.

∫ Menu item
[MASTER PED] (l 157)

Gamma function
This function optimizes the tone of images.

∫ Menu item
[GAMMA MODE]:
[BLACK GAMMA]:

Sets the optimal tone and contrast of images for the scene to be
recorded. (l 157)
Sets the gamma curve for dark areas.(l 157)

Knee function
This function sets the compression of video signals to prevent white saturation in images.

∫ Menu item
[KNEE MODE]:

[KNEE MASTER POINT]:
[KNEE MASTER SLOPE]:

Sets the compression level of highly bright image signals
received by the image sensor to minimize white saturation.
(l 158)
Adjusts the knee point position in 0.5% steps. (l 158)
Sets the knee inclination. (l 158)

- 47 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

48 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Using the zoom
The unit can deliver a maximum optical zoom of 20k.
≥ (When the picture size of [REC FORMAT] (l 161) is 1920k1080 or below)
It can zoom up to approx. 30k when the [i.Zoom] is set to [ON]. (l 49)
≥ You can check the zoom magnification on-screen, displayed as a value between Z00 and Z99.
The value gets larger as you zoom in, and smaller as you zoom out.
≥ You can change the unit of the on-screen zoom magnification display by changing the [ZOOM
DISPLAY] setting in the [DISP SETUP] menu. You can also change the setting so that the onscreen display does not appear. (l 193)
≥ When [FOCUS MACRO] is set to [OFF], subjects at a distance of approximately 1.0 m to infinity
can be brought into focus. When [FOCUS MACRO] is set to [ON] and the zoom position is at the
W end, subjects at a distance of approximately 10 cm to infinity can be brought into focus.
(l 102, 172)

Zoom lever 1/Sub zoom lever 2
T

T side:
Close-up recording (zoom in)
W side:

W

Wide-angle recording (zoom out)

T
W

A

Zoom ring 3
A side:

B

Wide-angle recording (zoom out)
B side:
Close-up recording (zoom in)

≥ If you take your finger off the zoom lever during zoom operation, the operation sound may be
recorded. When returning the zoom lever to the original position, move it quietly.
≥ The zoom magnification is maintained even after this unit is turned off.

- 48 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

49 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using the i.Zoom
When [i.Zoom] is set to [ON], you can zoom in while maintaining the beauty of high-definition picture
quality up to a magnification of approx. 30k.
≥ Set [REC FORMAT] to a setting with a picture size of 1920k1080 or below. (l 161)

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [i.Zoom] # [ON]

≥ You can also use i.Zoom by registering [i.ZOOM] to a USER button. (l 102)
≥ The zoom magnification display will change.
(Example)
j iZ00 to iZ99: magnification levels that fall in the optical zoom range
j Z99: i.Zoom
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j When the size in [REC FORMAT] is set to 4K (4096k2160) or UHD (3840k2160)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)

Using Fast Zoom
When [FAST ZOOM] is set to [ON], you can use Fast Zoom while operating the zoom with the zoom
lever.

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [SW SETUP] # [FAST ZOOM] # [ON]

Push the zoom lever fully to operate the zoom.

≥ The zoom magnification display changes when using Fast Zoom. (Example:

99)

∫ About the zoom speed
≥ The zoom speed will vary depending on how far the zoom lever is pressed or how fast the zoom
ring is rotated.
≥ The zoom operation using the sub zoom lever will be performed at a constant speed. Zoom
speed of the sub zoom lever will vary depending on the setting of [SUB ZOOM]. (l 174)
≥ You can also use Fast Zoom by registering [FAST ZOOM] to a USER button. (l 82)
≥ The sound of the zoom mechanism becomes louder than usual during fast zoom operation. This
may cause the sound to be recorded during recording.
≥ Depending on the subject, Auto Focus may not track it when Fast Zoom is in use.

Utilizing the USER button
Digital Zoom can be used by registering [D.ZOOM] to a USER button. (l 87)
≥ Please refer to page 82 for details about setting the USER button.

- 49 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

50 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Image Stabilizer Function
Use the Image Stabilizer to reduce the effects of shake during recording.
This unit is equipped with Hybrid Optical Image Stabilizer.
Hybrid Optical Image Stabilizer is a hybrid of Optical and Electrical Image Stabilizer.

1

Register [O.I.S.] to a USER button. (l 82)

≥ This function is registered to the USER6 button by default.

2

Press the USER button to which [O.I.S.] is registered or touch the applicable
USER button icon to switch the Image Stabilizer on/off.
/

#

(OFF)

≥ You can also access this function by selecting menu items.
[SW SETUP] # [O.I.S.] # [ON]/[OFF]
≥ When [HYBRID O.I.S.] is [ON],
is displayed. When [OFF],
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame (l 89)

is displayed.

∫ Changing Image Stabilizer Mode
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [HYBRID O.I.S.] # [ON] or [OFF]

When set to [ON], you can further improve image stabilization for holding the unit and recording a
distant subject with zoom.
≥ Optical Image Stabilizer will be disabled and the setting cannot be changed in the following
cases:
j When Optical Image Stabilizer is set to
(setting canceled)
j When the size is set to 4K (4096k2160) or UHD (3840k2160) in [REC FORMAT] (l 161)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ The setting cannot be changed during Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ Stabilization may not be possible under strong shaking conditions.
≥ When using a tripod, we recommend that you set the Image Stabilizer to

(setting canceled).

Customizing the Image Stabilizer for various recording conditions
You can customize the Image Stabilizer by adjusting the [BLUR AMPLITUDE] and [BLUR
FREQUENCY] settings individually.

∫ Custom Optical Image Stabilizer
When [ON] is selected, the Image Stabilizer works with customized [BLUR AMPLITUDE] and
[BLUR FREQUENCY] settings.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [CUSTOM O.I.S.] # [ON]

- 50 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

51 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ The setting is fixed to [OFF] in the following case:
j When the size in [REC FORMAT] is set to 4K (4096k2160) (l 161)

∫ Blur amplitude
You can adjust the performance of camera shake correction according to the level of camera shake
during recording.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [BLUR AMPLITUDE] # desired setting

[1]/[2]/[3]/[4]/[5]
≥ If you set a smaller value, correction performance against minor camera shake will be enhanced.
Even though smaller values allow more effective screen stabilization in situations with minor
camera shake, such as when you are recording from a fixed position, they are less effective for
correcting significant camera shake. We recommend setting a smaller value when you keep
recording the same subject, for example.
≥ If you set a larger value, camera shake of varying degrees ranging from minor to significant will
be corrected in a balanced manner. Although larger values allow you to correct significant camera
shake more effectively, the screen becomes unstable when you are recording from a fixed
position. We recommend that you set a larger value in situations where images are expected to
be quite blurry, such as when recording in an unstable position.

∫ Blur frequency
You can change the target frequency range for camera shake correction to adjust its performance
according to the recording style.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [BLUR FREQUENCY] # desired setting

[1]: This enhances the correction performance against camera shake of varying degrees, ranging
from slow camera shake that falls in the low frequency range to fast and subtle camera shake
that falls in the high frequency range. We recommend that you select this setting when
recording a subject from a fixed position without panning or tilting this unit.
[2]: This is a standard setting which enhances the correction performance against camera shake
that falls in the average-to-high frequency range. Even while adjusting the position of this
unit, you can keep the resulting motion in the image look natural and maintain the correction
performance.
[3]: This mainly enhances the correction performance against fast and subtle camera shake that
falls in the high frequency range while weakening the correction performance against slow
camera shake that falls in the low frequency range. We recommend that you use this setting
when panning or tilting this unit many times while recording.

- 51 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

52 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Focus
Perform focus adjustments using the focus ring. If auto focusing is difficult due to the conditions,
then use Manual Focus.
A
B
C

FOCUS
A
M
∞



PUSH AUTO

FOCUS A/M/¶ switch
PUSH AUTO button
Focus ring





≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

1

Set the FOCUS A/M/¶ switch to [M] to enable Manual Focus.

≥ It will switch to MF from AF.

2

Adjust the focus by rotating the focus ring.

≥ The focus value can be set from MF00 (Focus distance*: approximately 10.0 cm [When [FOCUS
MACRO] (l 102, 172) is set to [ON]]) to MF99 (Focus distance*: infinity). The larger the focus
value gets, the further the position where focus is achieved.
* Focus distance refers to the minimum distance where a subject can be brought into focus.
≥ If you move the FOCUS A/M/¶ switch towards [¶], focus will be adjusted to MF95 on the infinity
side. (The FOCUS A/M/¶ switch will return to the [M] position.)
≥ To return to Auto Focus, set the FOCUS A/M/¶ switch to [A], or set [AF] to [ON] and switch to
Auto Mode. (l 44)
≥ If you set [FOCUS MACRO] to [ON], when the distance to the subject approaches within 0.95 m
approx., the unit switches to the macro range and
or
. (The unit may switch to the macro
range even when the distance to the subject is 0.95 m or more depending on the subject.)
≥ Depending on the zoom magnification, this unit may fail to switch to the macro range, or go to a
non-displayed focus value.
≥ When you perform a zoom operation in the macro range, this unit may go out of focus.
≥ When [AF] is set to [ON] and this unit is set to Auto Mode, auto focusing is performed regardless
of the position of FOCUS A/M/¶ switch. (l 44)
≥ The unit of the focus value display varies depending on the [FOCUS DISPLAY] setting in the
[DISP SETUP] menu. You can also change the setting so that the on-screen display does not
appear. (l 193)

- 52 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

53 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ To change the way you adjust focus with the focus ring
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [FOCUS RING DRIVE]

[SPEED]:

Adjusts the focus value according to the speed at which the focus ring is
rotated.

[COARSE]:

Adjusts the focus value according to the rotational position of the focus
ring. Since the operation of the focus ring results in a greater change in
focus value, this setting is suitable for making rough adjustments.

[FINE]:

Adjusts the focus value according to the rotational position of the focus
ring. Since the operation of the focus ring results in a smaller change in
focus value, this setting is suitable for making fine adjustments.

∫ To emphasize the outline of images
Setting [EVF/LCD DETAIL] to [ON] helps you achieve focus easier by emphasizing the outlines of
an image displayed on the LCD monitor and viewfinder.
You can also adjust the emphasis level or change the frequency.
≥ You can also enable or disable this function with the applicable USER button. (l 91)
≥ These settings will not affect the images actually recorded.
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # [EVF/LCD DETAIL] # [ON]

Adjusting the level of [EVF/LCD DETAIL]
1 Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [DISP SETUP] # [EVF/LCD PEAK LEVEL]

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s3 and r3.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

Setting the peaking frequency of [EVF/LCD DETAIL]
Select the menu.
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # [EVF/LCD PEAK FREQ.] # [HIGH] or [LOW]

≥ [EVF/LCD DETAIL] is canceled in following cases:
j If you use Focus Assist (peaking) (l 56)

- 53 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

54 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Customizing Auto Focus for various recording conditions
You can customize Auto Focus for various recording conditions by adjusting the settings of [AF
SPEED], [AF SENSITIVITY], and [AF AREA WIDTH] individually.

∫ Custom AF function
When [ON] is selected, Auto Focus works with customized [AF SPEED] and [AF SENSITIVITY] settings.
≥ Switch to Auto Focus Mode. (l 52)

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [CUSTOM AF] # [ON]

∫ AF speed setup
You can change the focus speed of Auto Focus.
≥ Switch to Auto Focus Mode. (l 52)
≥ Set [CUSTOM AF] to [ON].

1

Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [SW SETUP] # [AF SPEED]

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between j5 and i5.
≥ The larger the value is, the faster the focus speed will become. Conversely, the smaller the value
is, the slower the focus speed will become.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

∫ AF Sensitivity setup
You can enhance the stability or tracking performance of Auto Focus.
≥ Switch to Auto Focus Mode. (l 52)
≥ Set [CUSTOM AF] to [ON].

1

Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [SW SETUP] # [AF SENSITIVITY]

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 0 and 10.
≥ Setting a larger value will enhance the tracking performance of focus, making it easier to move
focus between subjects at varying distances from this unit. We recommend that you set a larger
value to keep focus on a fast-moving subject.
≥ Setting a smaller value will provide more stability to focus, making it easier to keep focus on the
targeted subject even when an intervening object passes in front of the camera or the subject
disappears from the view of this unit. We recommend that you set a smaller value to avoid
bringing an intervening object or the background into focus.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j In manual focus mode (l 52)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ When a faster [AF SPEED] value is selected, focus mechanism noise will be more audible. As a
result, the noise may be recorded while recording is in progress.

- 54 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

55 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ AF Area Width Adjustment
You can adjust the effective area width for Auto Focus according to the size of the subject.
≥ Switch to Auto Focus Mode. (l 52)

1

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [AF AREA WIDTH] # [SET]

2

Push the jog dial.

3

Rotate the jog dial to adjust the AF area
frame.

A
B
C

[RETURN]
AF area frame
[EXIT]

4

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ AF-AREA will be displayed on the screen.







≥ To cancel the settings, set [AF AREA WIDTH] to [OFF].
≥ If you push the jog dial in Step 2, the AF area frame turns yellow, allowing you to select
[RETURN]/[EXIT] by rotating the jog dial. Push the jog dial to set the selected item.
≥ You can also adjust AF area width by registering [AF AREA] to a USER button. (l 99)
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j In manual focus mode (l 52)
j When using Area Mode (l 90)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)

One Push AF
If you press the PUSH AUTO button in Manual Focus Mode, the camera performs high-speed
focusing until the image is focused.
≥ Switch to Manual Focus Mode. (l 52)

Press PUSH AUTO button.
≥ Auto Focus will be activated and the camera will perform high-speed focusing until the image is
focused.
≥ The focus setting returns to Manual Focus Mode once the image is focused or a certain time has
elapsed.
≥ You can also use One Push AF with the USER button to which [PUSH AUTO] is registered.
(l 82)
≥ One Push AF does not work in following cases:
j When Auto Focus is used

- 55 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

56 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Push AF
If you press and hold the PUSH AUTO button, Manual Focus will be temporarily switched to Auto
Focus.
≥ Set this unit to Manual Focus. (l 52)

Press and hold the PUSH AUTO button.
≥ The focus position will be automatically adjusted for the subject at the center of the screen.
≥ If you set [AREA MODE] to [FOCUS], [FOCUS/IRIS] or [FOCUS/Y GET] and use Area Mode, the
focus position will be automatically adjusted to the subject you have touched. (l 90)
≥ It will be canceled when the button is released, and the focus position set by the Push AF will be
maintained.
≥ You can also use Push AF with the USER button to which [PUSH AUTO] is registered. (l 82)
≥ Push AF does not work in following cases:
j When Auto Focus is used

Focus Assist
You can use Focus Assist by pressing the FOCUS ASSIST button or the USER button to which
[FOCUS ASSIST 1] or [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered.
≥ For information on how to set the USER buttons, refer to page 82.

Selecting a Focus Assist method
∫ To select the Focus Assist method for the FOCUS ASSIST button or
the USER button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 1] is registered
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [FOCUS ASSIST 1] # desired setting

[EXPAND]:

Magnifies the central area of the screen when Focus Assist is used.

[PEAKING]:

Highlights in-focus portions with color when Focus Assist is used.

[BOTH]:

Sets both [EXPAND] and [PEAKING].

∫ To select the Focus Assist method for the USER button to which
[FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [FOCUS ASSIST 2] # desired setting

[EXPAND] / [PEAKING]
≥ You can use the magnified display and the peaking function separately or use them in
combination by selecting different settings for [FOCUS ASSIST 1] and [FOCUS ASSIST 2].
≥ If [FOCUS ASSIST 1] is set to [BOTH], [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is not available. In addition, the USER
button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered is disabled.

- 56 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

57 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using Focus Assist
≥ Switch to Manual Focus Mode. (l 52)

Press the FOCUS ASSIST button or the USER button
to which [FOCUS ASSIST 1] or [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is
registered.

FOCUS
ASSIST

≥ You can also use Focus Assist by touching the USER button
icon to which [FOCUS ASSIST 1] or [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is
registered.
≥ To turn off Focus Assist, perform the following operations:
j Press the FOCUS ASSIST button or the USER button again,
or touch the USER button icon again.
j Touch [EXIT].

∫ To adjust the magnified display
If you set Focus Assist to ON by following either of the procedures below, the central area of the
screen will be magnified. You can change the magnification and position of the magnified display.
j Setting the menu item [FOCUS ASSIST 1] to [EXPAND] or [BOTH] and pressing the FOCUS
ASSIST button or the USER button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 1] is registered.
j Setting the menu item [FOCUS ASSIST 2] to [EXPAND] and pressing the USER button to
which [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered.
≥ You can also change the magnification level of the magnified display using the jog dial.





x5.5

x3.0










SEL/
PUSH
SET

A
B
C
D
E
F



3k–5k display
5.5k–10k display
[ASSIST]
Magnified display
[EXIT]
Jog dial

(To change the magnification level)

Touch

/

or rotate the jog dial to change the magnification level.

:

Increases the magnification level by 0.5k.

:

Decreases the magnification level by 0.5k.

≥ You can adjust the magnification from 3k to 10k.
(Moving the magnified area)

Touch
area.

/

/

/

or slide the screen while touching it to move the magnified

- 57 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

58 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ To change the peaking settings

If you set Focus Assist to ON by following either of the
procedures below, in-focus portions are highlighted with
color (peaking).
j Setting the menu item [FOCUS ASSIST 1] to
[PEAKING] or [BOTH] and pressing the FOCUS
ASSIST button or the USER button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 1] is registered.
j Setting the menu item [FOCUS ASSIST 2] to [PEAKING] and pressing the USER button to
which [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered.
G: Peaking
≥ You can set the peaking color and strength.
(When changing the peaking color)

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [PEAKING COLOUR] # desired color

[Red]/[Blue]/[Yellow]/[White]
(When setting the peaking strength)

1

Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [SW SETUP] # [PEAKING LEVEL] # desired setting

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s7 and r7.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

(Notes on Focus Assist)
≥ Focus Assist is not possible in following cases:
j During Recording Check (l 88)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j When color bars are displayed (l 106)
≥ Focus Assist is canceled in following cases:
j If you turn the unit off
j (If you operate the FOCUS ASSIST button or the USER button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 1] is
registered)
When the setting of [FOCUS ASSIST 1] (l 56) is changed
j (If you operate the USER button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered)
When the setting of [FOCUS ASSIST 2] (l 56) is changed
j When you set this unit to Auto Focus
j When you press the USER button to which [FOCUS TRANS] is registered or touch the
applicable USER button icon (l 61)
≥ The magnified display and peaking are not displayed on recorded images.
≥ The magnified display and peaking are not displayed on an external monitor.
≥ Freeze Frame is not available when you use Focus Assist. (l 89)

- 58 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

59 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ Peaking may not be displayed when you use Digital Zoom (l 87). To zoom in and use peaking at
the same time, we recommend increasing the magnification level of the magnified display by
setting [FOCUS ASSIST 1] to [BOTH] or by using the magnified display and the peaking function
in combination.
(Notes on the peaking of Focus Assist)
≥ When EVF/LCD detail is enabled, Focus Assist is canceled. (l 53)
(Notes on the magnified display of Focus Assist)
≥ Some information on the screen disappears when the screen is magnified.
≥ In the following cases, the screen is not magnified during Focus Assist:
j During motion picture recording or PRE-REC (l 95, 183)
j When using Digital Zoom
j When using Area Mode (l 90)
j During auto recording (l 98)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During AG ROP application connection (l 141)
≥ If you set the magnification level of the magnified display to 5.5k or higher, peaking may not be
displayed when using i.Zoom (l 48).

Manual Focus Assist
Focus is automatically adjusted after you adjust it with the focus ring in Manual Focus Mode.
≥ Focus may not be achieved when the focus deviation is great.
≥ After automatic adjustment is complete, the focus is not adjusted automatically again until you
operate the focus ring.
≥ Switch to Manual Focus Mode. (l 52)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [MF ASSIST] # [ON]

≥ Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.
≥ The on-screen icon changes from [MF] to [MA].

2

Adjust the focus by rotating the focus ring.

≥ Focus is automatically adjusted after you adjust it with the focus ring.
≥ The color of the on-screen icon for the focus value changes during automatic adjustment.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When Auto Focus is used
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ The on-screen icon changes to
in the macro range.
≥ Manual focus assist does not work in following cases:
j When adjusting the focus with the remote control (commercially-available) (l 125)

- 59 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

60 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Focus Transition
You can use Focus Transition by registering [FOCUS TRANS] to a USER button. With Focus
Transition, you can shift the current focus position to a pre-registered focus position.
≥ Please refer to page 82 for details about setting the USER button.

Registering a focus position
To use Focus Transition, you need to register a focus position.
≥ You can register up to 3 focus positions.
≥ Switch to Manual Focus Mode. (l 52)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [RECORD SETUP] # [FOCUS TRANSITION] # [SET]

Touch the item to which you want to register the focus position.

[1]/[2]/[3]
≥ You can select the item by pressing the USER buttons 1s3.
≥ The Focus Assist screen will be displayed.
≥ The screen may not be magnified depending on your settings.

3
4

Adjust the focus by rotating the focus ring.
Touch [ENTER].

≥ The icon of the item to which the focus position has been registered will be highlighted in yellow.
≥ To select a different item, perform the operations in Steps 2s4.

5

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ The focus positions of the items you have set will be registered.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When Auto Focus is used
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ The focus position settings are canceled in the following cases:
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j If you operate the zoom
j If you enable or disable Infrared Recording Mode

- 60 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

61 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using Focus Transition
≥ Select the [FOCUS TRANSITION] menu. (l 60)
≥ Register [FOCUS TRANS] to a USER button. (l 82)

1
2
3

Switch to Manual Focus Mode. (l 52)
Press the USER button to which [FOCUS TRANS] is registered or touch the
applicable USER button icon.
Touch a registered item ([1]s[3]).

≥ Focus Transition will start. Focus will shift slowly from the
current position to the registered position. This will take a
few seconds. (l 62)
≥ As the focus shifts, the Focus Transition bar will move
from [S] to [E].

4

Touch [EXIT] to exit Focus Transition.

MF50
S

E

2

1


A
B

3


[EXIT]
Focus Transition bar

≥ If you move this unit a lot after setting the focus position, focus may not stop at the set position.
≥ When Focus Transition is in use, focus cannot be adjusted with the focus ring.
≥ Focus Transition is not available in the following cases:
j When Auto Focus is used
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j When color bars are displayed. (l 106)
j When a remote control (commercially-available) is connected (l 125)
j During AG ROP application connection (l 141)
≥ Focus Transition settings are canceled in the following cases. To use Focus Transition again,
register a focus position again. (l 60)
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j If you operate the zoom
j If you enable or disable Infrared Recording Mode
≥ When Focus Transition is in use, only the USER button functions below are available. Press the
applicable USER button (one of the USER buttons 5 to 9 button) to use them. (l 84)
j [FOCUS ASSIST 1]
j [FOCUS ASSIST 2]
j [FOCUS TRANS]
j [IR REC]
j [BACKGROUND]

j [PRE-REC]
j [USB MODE]
j [EVF ON/OFF]
j [AUTO REC]
j [MENU]

≥ You can switch between the items or exit Focus Transition by pressing the USER buttons 1s4.
USER button

Corresponding setting

USER1 to USER3

[1] to [3]

USER4

[EXIT]

≥ When using Focus Transition, functions registered to the USER buttons 1s4 do not work with the USER buttons.

- 61 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

62 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

To set the Focus Transition time
1 Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [RECORD SETUP] # [FOCUS TRANSITION TIME]

Touch the desired setting item.

[DIRECT]/[FASTEST]/[2-15 SEC.]/[20 SEC.]/[30 SEC.]/[45 SEC.]/[60 SEC.]/[90 SEC.]
≥ If you select [DIRECT], the focus position changes as soon as Focus Transition starts, but the
operating noise of the lens may be recorded.
3 (If you have selected [2-15 SEC.] in Step 2)

Touch

/

to set the duration.

≥ You can set a Focus Transition time of 2s15 seconds (by 0.5 second increments).
≥ Touch [RETURN].

4

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

To start Focus Transition and recording simultaneously
You can start Focus Transition and recording simultaneously by enabling
[FOCUS TRANSITION REC].

1

Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [RECORD SETUP] # [FOCUS TRANSITION REC]

Touch the item.

[1]/[2]/[3]

3
4
5

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.
When the recording screen is displayed, press the USER button to which
[FOCUS TRANS] is registered or touch the applicable USER button icon.
Press the recording start/stop button or the USER button to which [AUTO
REC] is registered.

≥ Recording and Focus Transition will start simultaneously. Focus will shift to the position you have
set in Step 2.

To set the length of time before Focus Transition starts
Select the menu.
MENU

: [RECORD SETUP] # [FOCUS TRANSITION WAIT] # desired time

[0 SEC.]/[5 SEC.]/[10 SEC.]

- 62 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

63 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

White Balance
Automatic White Balance function may not reproduce natural colors depending on the scenes or
lighting conditions. If so, you can adjust the White Balance manually.

5600K Ach



ヴユロバ
ヱヶヴラ
ヴユヵ





WHITE BAL



A White Balance
B Color temperature display
≥ Displayed when the White Balance mode is set to Ach or Bch.
≥ The color temperature display is not guaranteed to indicate an exact value. Use the indicated
value only as a guide.
1
2

Jog dial
WHITE BAL button

≥ Register [AWB] to a USER button. (l 82)
This function is registered to the USER9 button by default.
≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

1

Press the WHITE BAL button to switch to [Ach], [Bch], or [PRST].

≥ The setting changes each time you press the button.
[Ach] # [Bch] # [PRST]
≥ If you switch to [PRST], the White Balance mode set in [WB PRESET] will be displayed.

2

(If you have switched to [PRST])
Press the USER button to which [AWB] is registered or touch the applicable
USER button icon to change the White Balance mode.

≥ The mode will change each time you press the USER button to which [AWB] is registered or
touch the applicable USER button icon.
[P3200K] # [P5600K] # [VAR]
≥ It is not possible to change the White Balance mode without registering [AWB] to a USER button.
≥ If you set the White Balance mode to [ATW] in by following either of the procedures below, the
White Balance mode cannot be changed even if you press the USER button to which [AWB] is
registered or touch the applicable USER button icon.
j Pressing the USER button to which [ATW] is registered (l 82, 87)
j Pressing the WHITE BAL button to switch to the item (Ach/Bch/PRST) setting in [ATW SET]
(l 170)

- 63 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

64 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

About White Balance modes
Display (Mode)

Settings

ATW (ATW)*1

It will automatically adjust in accordance with the recording condition.

LOCK
(ATW Lock)*2

It will lock the setting for ATW. (l 65)

P3200K
(P3200K)

Preset value for studio/indoor recording (halogen lamp, etc.)

P5600K
(P5600K)

Preset value for outdoors

VAR (VAR)

Setting can be finely adjusted in accordance to the recording conditions.
(l 66)

Ach (Ach)

Setting can be optimized for the scene to be recorded when you press the
WHITE BAL button to switch to [Ach]. (l 66)

Bch (Bch)

Setting can be optimized for the scene to be recorded when you press the
WHITE BAL button to switch to [Bch]. (l 66)

*1

This setting is selected automatically when one of the following operations is performed:
j Set [ATW] to [ON] and switch to Auto Mode. (l 44)
j Press the USER button to which [ATW] is registered. (l 82, 87)
j Pressing the WHITE BAL button to switch to the item (Ach/Bch/PRST) setting in [ATW SET]
(l 170)
*2 You can enable this mode by pressing the USER button to which [ATW LOCK] is registered.
≥ In the following cases, even if you press the USER button to which [ATW] is registered or press
the WHITE BAL button, the White Balance mode cannot be changed:
j In Auto Mode with [ATW] set to [ON]
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ Changing the settings in [RB GAIN CONTROL SETTING] allows you to fine-adjust the color
balance settings of [Ach] and [Bch]. (l 154)

- 64 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

65 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Customizing ATW for various recording conditions
You can customize the ATW settings for various recording conditions by adjusting the settings of
[ATW TARGET R] and [ATW TARGET B] individually.

∫ Fine-adjusting the color balance of ATW
1

Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [ATW TARGET R] or [ATW TARGET B]

≥ [ATW TARGET R] adjusts the intensity of red.
≥ [ATW TARGET B] adjusts the intensity of blue.

2

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s10 and r10.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

To set ATW Lock
You can set ATW Lock by registering [ATW LOCK] to a USER button.
≥ Please refer to page 82 for details about setting the USER button.

1
2

Set the White Balance mode to [ATW].
Press the USER button to which [ATW LOCK] is registered or touch the
applicable USER button icon.

≥ To cancel ATW Lock, press the USER button or touch the USER button icon again. Canceling
ATW Lock will return the White Balance mode back to [ATW].
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When the White Balance mode is set to something other than [ATW]
≥ It will be canceled when the unit is turned off.

- 65 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

66 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

To finely adjust the White Balance
Setting the White Balance mode to [VAR] allows you to set a White Balance value between 2000K
and 15000K.
≥ Use the jog dial to change the settings.
≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

1

Set the White Balance mode to [VAR]. (l 63)

2

Rotate the jog dial to adjust the color balance.

3

Push the jog dial to finish the adjustment.

≥ You can also access this setting by selecting menu items.
[SW SETUP] # [WB VAR] (l 171)
≥ The set value is not guaranteed to be an exact value. Use it only as a guide.

To set the White Balance in accordance to the recording scene
≥ Register [AWB] to a USER button. (l 82)

1
2
3

Fill the screen with a white subject or place a white piece of paper in front of
the lens.
Press the WHITE BAL button to switch to [Ach] or [Bch].
Press the USER button to which [AWB] is registered or touch the applicable
USER button icon to set the Auto White Balance mode.

≥ Adjust the Black Balance first, and then the White Balance. The screen goes dark momentarily,
“WB SET OK” is displayed, and the adjustment ends.
≥ If you have pressed the USER button to which [AWB] is registered or touched the applicable
USER button icon, only the White Balance is adjusted. When “WB SET OK” is displayed, the
adjustment is complete.
≥ When the White Balance mode is set to a setting other than [Ach] or [Bch], if you press and hold
the USER button to which [AWB] is registered or touch and hold the applicable USER button icon
while recording is paused, Auto Black Balance will operate. Setting is completed when the screen
goes black momentarily and “BB SET OK” is displayed.
≥ When the Auto White Balance/Auto Black Balance cannot be performed, an error message
“WB SET NG” or “BB SET NG” is displayed on the screen. In such case, use other mode.
≥ It is not possible to operate Auto White Balance or Auto Black Balance without registering [AWB]
to a USER button.
≥ The contents previously set are maintained in the [Ach] or [Bch]. Perform the setting again when
the recording condition has changed.
≥ A color temperature value that is displayed after Auto White Balance is enabled is not guaranteed
to be an exact value. Use it only as a guide.

- 66 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

67 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Iris/Gain adjustment
When recording a scene that is too dark (or bright) or a scene in a similar situation, manually adjust
the iris and gain.

Iris adjustment

F4.0

IRIS







A Iris value
B Auto iris icon*
* It is displayed in Auto Iris Mode.

1
2



IRIS button
Iris ring

≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

1
≥

2

Press the IRIS button to switch to Manual Iris Mode.
disappears.

Adjust the iris by rotating the iris ring.

Iris value:
CLOSE !# (F11 to F3.0) !# OPEN
≥ Value closer to CLOSE darken the image.
≥ Value closer to OPEN brighten the image.
≥ To return to Auto Iris Mode, press the IRIS button, or set [A.IRIS] to [ON] and switch to Auto
Mode. (l 44)
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)
≥ Depending on the zoom magnification, there are iris values that are not displayed.
≥ In Auto Gain Mode or Auto Shutter Mode, the screen brightness may not change even if you
adjust the iris. (l 69, 71)

- 67 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

68 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Customizing Auto Iris motion settings for various recording conditions
You can customize Auto Iris motion settings for various recording conditions by adjusting the
settings of [AUTO IRIS LEVEL] and [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT] individually.

∫ Adjusting brightness during the Auto Iris Mode
1

Select the [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT] menu.
MENU

2

: [SCENE FILE] # [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT]

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s50 and r50.
≥ Touch [EXIT].

3

Select the [AUTO IRIS LEVEL] menu.
MENU

: [SCENE FILE] # [AUTO IRIS LEVEL] # [ON]

≥ If you select [OFF], the [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT] setting will not be applied.

4

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ You can also change the [AUTO IRIS LEVEL] setting with a USER button. (l 97)

Utilizing the USER button
It is convenient to use following functions of the USER button when it is set to Iris adjustment.
≥ Please refer to page 82 for details about setting the USER button.
USER button function

Effect

[BACKLIGHT] (l 85)

Switches to automatic iris control to compensate the
backlight. This will brighten the image on the screen to
prevent getting dark when a backlight is hitting the subject
from the back.

[SPOTLIGHT] (l 86)

Switches to automatic iris control for spotlight. This will allow
to clearly record an extremely bright subject.

- 68 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

69 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Gain adjustment
≥ Use the jog dial to change the settings.

0dB



ヴユロバ
ヱヶヴラ
ヴユヵ



GAIN

1
2




Jog dial
GAIN button

A Gain value
≥ In Auto Gain Mode, “AGC” is displayed; in Manual Gain Mode, the gain value is displayed in dB.
B [GAIN]
≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

1

Press the GAIN button to switch to [LOW GAIN], [MID GAIN], or [HIGH GAIN].

≥ The setting changes each time you press the button.
[LOW GAIN] # [MID GAIN] # [HIGH GAIN]
≥ It is possible to register gain values to [LOW GAIN], [MID GAIN], and [HIGH GAIN] and switch
between these values. (l 168, 169)
≥ It is also possible to switch to the desired gain value by pressing the USER button to which
[LOW GAIN], [MID GAIN] or [HIGH GAIN] is registered. (l 105)

2

Push the jog dial.

3

Adjust the gain by rotating the jog dial.
Gain value:
0 dB to 24 dB
≥ Value closer to 0 dB darken the image.
≥ Value closer to 24 dB brighten the image.
≥ When [EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] is set to [ON], you can set a value between -3 dB and 24 dB.
(l 165)
≥ The selected gain value is not maintained if any of the following operations is performed:
j Pressing the GAIN button
j Switching to Auto Gain Mode
j Switching to Infrared Recording Mode (l 92, 183)
≥ Auto Gain Mode is activated when one of the following operations is performed:
j Setting [AGC] to [ON] and switching to Auto Mode (l 44)
j Setting [LOW GAIN], [MID GAIN] or [HIGH GAIN] to [AUTO] and then pressing the GAIN
button to switch to the applicable gain setting.

- 69 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

70 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ It is not possible to adjust the gain value using the GAIN button and jog dial in the following
situations:
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ If the gain value is increased, the noise on the screen increases.
≥ In Auto Iris Mode or Auto Shutter Mode, the screen brightness may not change even if you adjust
the gain. (l 67, 71)
≥ When a negative gain value (a value between -3 dB and -1 dB) is selected, if you set
[EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] to [OFF], the gain value will be set to 0 dB.

∫ Changing the maximum possible gain value for Auto Gain Mode
Select the menu.
MENU

: [AUTO SW] # [AGC LIMIT] # desired setting

[3 dB]/[6 dB]/[9 dB]/[12 dB]/[15 dB]/[18 dB]/[21 dB]/[24 dB]

Super Gain
You can use Super Gain by registering [SUPER GAIN] to a USER button.
Super Gain allows you to set the gain value to 30 dB or 36 dB.
≥ Please refer to page 82 for details about setting the USER button.
≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

Press the USER button to which [SUPER GAIN] is registered or touch the
applicable USER button icon.
≥ To cancel Super gain, press the USER button or touch the USER button icon again.

∫ To change the gain value of Super Gain
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [SUPER GAIN] # desired setting

[30 dB]/[36 dB]
≥ Super Gain is not available in the following cases:
j In Auto Gain Mode
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j In High-sensitivity Recording Mode (l 166)
≥ Super Gain will be canceled if you set [HIGH SENS. MODE] to [HIGH SENS.].

- 70 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

71 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Manual shutter speed
Adjust the shutter speed when recording fast-moving subjects.
≥ Use the jog dial to change the settings.

SHUTTER

A.SHTR 1/60







ヴユロバ
ヱヶヴラ
ヴユヵ

A Shutter speed
B Auto Shutter display
≥ This is displayed in Auto Shutter Mode.
C [SHUTTER]

1
2




SHUTTER button
Jog dial

≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

1
2

Press the SHUTTER button to switch to Manual Shutter Mode.
Adjust the shutter speed by rotating the jog dial.

≥ To return to Auto Shutter Mode, press the SHUTTER button, or set
[AUTO SHUTTER] to [ON] and switch to Auto Mode. (l 44)
Shutter speed:
The shutter speed varies depending on the frame rate in [REC FORMAT]. (l 161)
Frame rates

Shutter speed

59.94p/59.94i

1/60.0*!#1/2!#1/4!#1/8!#1/15!#1/30!#1/60!#...1/8000

29.97p

1/60.0*!#1/2!#1/4!#1/8!#1/15!#1/30!#1/50!#...1/8000

50.00p/50.00i/25.00p

1/50.0*!#1/2!#1/3!#1/6!#1/12!#1/25!#1/50!#...1/8000

23.98p/24.00p

1/48.0*!#1/2!#1/3!#1/6!#1/12!#1/24!#1/48!#...1/8000

* Synchro Scan values (l 73)
≥ The shutter speed closer to 1/8000 is faster.

- 71 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

72 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Shutter speed guide for fast moving subjects
Refer to the table below to reduce afterimages that appear when playback is paused.
Subject

Shutter speed

Golf or tennis shot

1/500 to 1/2000

Roller coaster

1/500 to 1/1000

≥ The shutter speed cannot be adjusted in the following cases:
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ You may see a band of light around an object that is shining very bright, or highly reflective.
≥ During normal playback, image movement may not look smooth.
≥ If you record an extremely bright object or record under indoor lighting, color and screen
brightness may change or a horizontal line may appear on the screen. In such cases, change
settings as follows:
j Set this unit to Auto Shutter Mode.
j Adjust the shutter speed to 1/50, 1/60 or 1/100.
j Adjust the Synchro Scan setting
≥ In Auto Iris Mode or Auto Gain Mode, the screen brightness may not change even if you adjust
the shutter speed. (l 67, 69)
≥ When the shutter speed setting is slow, this unit may not be able to keep up with changes in the
image. In such a case, set the iris, focus, and White Balance mode to manual settings.

- 72 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

73 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Making adjustments with Synchro Scan
If you press the jog dial when the shutter speed is displayed as a decimal number, the Synchro
Scan setting will be displayed. You can fine-adjust the shutter speed by adjusting the Synchro Scan
setting. This will minimize flickering and horizontal bars in images.

1
2

Press the SHUTTER button.
When the shutter is displayed as a decimal number (e.g.,
1/60.0), press the jog dial.

≥ The display on the screen will switch from [
SHUTTER] to
[
SYNCHRO], and the Synchro Scan setting will be displayed.

3

Adjust the Synchro Scan setting by rotating the jog dial.

≥ To minimize flickering and horizontal bands, look at the screen while adjusting the shutter speed.

4

Push the jog dial to set.

≥ The set shutter speed will also be applied to the [SYNCHRO SCAN] menu setting. (l 152)

Shutter speed range for the Synchro Scan setting
Depending on the size and frame rate in [REC FORMAT], the range of available shutter speeds
varies. (l 161)
Frame rates

Shutter speed

59.94p/59.94i

1/60.0 to 1/249.7

29.97p

1/30.0 to 1/249.7

23.98p

1/24.0 to 1/249.6

24.00p

1/24.0 to 1/249.9

50.00p/50.00i

1/50.0 to 1/250.0

25.00p

1/25.0 to 1/250.0

- 73 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

74 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Audio Input
This unit can record audio in 2 ch.
It is possible to switch between built-in microphone, external microphone, or connected audio
equipment for each channel.

∫ About audio recording methods
The audio recording method varies depending on the [REC MODE] setting. (l 160)
Recording mode

Audio recording method

MOV

Linear PCM (LPCM)

MP4
AVCHD

Dolby Digital

Switching Audio Input

CH1
SELECT

INPUT1



LINE
MIC
+48V



LINE
MIC
+48V

INT(L)
INPUT1
INPUT2

CH2
SELECT

INPUT2

A
B
C
D



INT(R)
INPUT1
INPUT2



INPUT1 switch
INPUT2 switch
CH1 SELECT switch
CH2 SELECT switch

∫ Using the built-in microphone
Audio is recorded with the built-in microphone (2 ch) when the CH1 SELECT switch is set to INT(L)
and the CH2 SELECT switch is set to INT(R).

∫ Using an external microphone or audio
equipment

1

Connect an external microphone or audio
equipment to AUDIO INPUT1, 2 terminals (XLR 3
pin). (l 22)
E
F

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin)
AUDIO INPUT2 terminal (XLR 3 pin)

- 74 -





HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

2

75 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Use INPUT1 or INPUT2 switches to switch the connected audio input signal.

LINE*1: Audio equipment is connected
MIC*2: An external microphone is connected
+48V*2: When using a phantom microphone (which requires a power supply of +48 V)
*1 The input level varies depending on the [INPUT1 LINE LEVEL] or [INPUT2 LINE LEVEL]
setting. (l 187)
*2 The input level varies depending on the [INPUT1 MIC LEVEL] or [INPUT2 MIC LEVEL] setting.
(l 187)

3

Use the CH1 SELECT switch to select the input signal to be recorded to
audio channel 1.

INT(L): Audio from the built-in microphone L (left) ch is recorded to audio channel 1.
INPUT1: Audio from a device connected to AUDIO INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin) is recorded to channel 1.
INPUT2: Audio from a device connected to AUDIO INPUT2 terminal (XLR 3 pin) is recorded to channel 1.

4

Use the CH2 SELECT switch to select the input signal to be recorded to
audio channel 2.

INT(R): Audio from the built-in microphone R (right) ch is recorded to audio channel 2.
INPUT1: Audio from a device connected to AUDIO INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin) is recorded to channel 2.
INPUT2: Audio from a device connected to AUDIO INPUT2 terminal (XLR 3 pin) is recorded to channel 2.

∫ Table of audio input patterns
Switch setting
CH1 SELECT
switch
INT(L)

INPUT1

INPUT2

Channel or terminal used for signal input

CH2 SELECT
switch

Audio channel 1

Audio channel 2

INT(R)

built-in microphone Lch

built-in microphone Rch

INPUT1

built-in microphone Lch

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal

INPUT2

built-in microphone Lch

AUDIO INPUT2 terminal

INT(R)

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal

built-in microphone Rch

INPUT1

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal

INPUT2

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal

AUDIO INPUT2 terminal

INT(R)

AUDIO INPUT2 terminal

built-in microphone Rch

INPUT1

AUDIO INPUT2 terminal

AUDIO INPUT1 terminal

INPUT2

AUDIO INPUT2 terminal

AUDIO INPUT2 terminal

To remove the external microphone, etc., from the AUDIO INPUT1, 2 terminals
(XLR 3 pin)

ヱヶヴラ

Remove while pushing on the PUSH section of the AUDIO
INPUT1, 2 terminals (XLR 3 pin).
≥ Set the input signal to built-in microphone by switching
the CH1 SELECT, CH2 SELECT switches to INT (L) or
INT (R) after removing the external microphone. Audio
will not be recorded when motion picture is recorded
without switching.
A

- 75 -

PUSH section

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

76 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ Set INPUT1, 2 switches to LINE or MIC if you connect equipment not compatible with
+48 V. You can damage this unit or such equipment if you leave the setting at [+48V].
≥ This unit is turned off when a problem occurs with the +48 V power supply.
≥ The battery will discharge faster if you use a phantom microphone.
≥ If there is noticeable noise coming from the terminal that is not in use, set the corresponding
INPUT switch (INPUT1, 2) to LINE.

Adjusting the audio input level
Selecting an adjustment method
You can set how to adjust the audio input level for each audio channel. For audio channel 1, select
[AUDIO LEVEL CH1]; for audio channel 2, select [AUDIO LEVEL CH2].

1

Select the menu.

MENU

: [AUDIO SETUP] # [AUDIO LEVEL CH1] or [AUDIO LEVEL CH2] # desired setting

[AUTO]:

Adjusts the level automatically.

[MANUAL]:

Adjusts the level manually.

2

(If you have set to [MANUAL])

Adjust the input level operating the AUDIO LEVEL CH1/AUDIO LEVEL CH2
knobs.

CH1

AUDIO
LEVEL

CH2

MNL
MNL

A
B
C
D

AUDIO LEVEL CH1/AUDIO LEVEL CH2 knobs
Audio level meter
-12 dB
0 dB

≥ Adjust confirming the audio level meter.

- 76 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

77 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using the ALC function
ALC can reduce audio noise. For audio channel 1, select [AUDIO ALC CH1]: for audio channel 2,
select [AUDIO ALC CH2].

1
2

Set [AUDIO LEVEL CH1]/[AUDIO LEVEL CH2] to [MANUAL]. (l 76)
Select the menu.

MENU

: [AUDIO SETUP] # [AUDIO ALC CH1] or [AUDIO ALC CH2] # desired setting

[ON]:

Enables ALC, allowing you to record audio with reduced noise.

[OFF]:

Allows you to record natural-sounding audio.

∫ To set the ALC function to both audio channels 1 and 2
If you set [AUDIO ALC LINK] to [ON], when ALC works for either of the audio channels, it will also
work for the other audio channel.

1
2
3

Set [AUDIO LEVEL CH1]/[AUDIO LEVEL CH2] to [MANUAL]. (l 76)
Set [AUDIO ALC CH1]/[AUDIO ALC CH2] to [ON].
Select the menu.
MENU

: [AUDIO SETUP] # [AUDIO ALC LINK] # [ON]

- 77 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

78 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Counter display
You can change a counter display that indicates how much time has elapsed during recording or
playback.




A
B

COUNTER

COUNTER button
RESET button

RESET

Press the COUNTER button to switch the counter display.
≥ The display will be switched in the following order: Time Code # User Information* # Recording
Counter # Off.
Counter display

Indications

Time Code

TC 00:00:00:00 or TC 00:00:00.00
≥ Display will change depending on the setting of the
[DF MODE]. (l 79)

User Information* (l 80)

UB 00 00 00 00

Recording Counter (l 81)

(In Recording Mode)
0:00:00 or SCN 0:00:00
(In Playback Mode)
SCN 0:00:00
≥ In Recording Mode, display will change depending on the
setting of the [REC COUNTER].
≥ In Playback Mode, display will return to SCN 0:00:00 for
each scene.

* This is displayed only when [REC MODE] is set to [AVCHD]. (l 160)

Setting the Time Code
Time code will display the recording time in hours, minutes, seconds, and frames.
TC 00:00:00:00 (hour : minute : second : frame [NDF])
TC 00:00:00.00 (hour : minute : second . frame [DF])
≥ The number of frames (frame count per second) varies depending on the frame rate in
[REC FORMAT]. (l 161)
Frame rates

Frame

59.94p/59.94i/29.97p

0 to 29

50.00p/50.00i/25.00p

0 to 24

23.98p/24.00p

0 to 23

- 78 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

79 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[DF MODE]
Select the compensation mode for the time code.
≥ Set [SYSTEM FREQ] to [59.94Hz]. (l 160)

Select the menu.
MENU

: [RECORD SETUP] # [DF MODE] # desired setting

[DF]:

Time code is compensated in accordance with the actual time. It is
mainly used for broadcasting such as TV programs.

[NDF]:

It will not compensate the time code. (There will be a difference from
the actual time)

≥ This item will be set to [NDF] automatically in following cases:
j When the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] is 23.98p or 24.00p (l 161)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
≥ This item will be automatically set to [NDF] and will not be displayed as a menu item when
[SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [50.00Hz]. (l 160)

[TCG]
Sets the way the time code will move.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [RECORD SETUP] # [TCG] # desired setting

[FREE RUN]*1:

It will constantly move.

[REC RUN]:

It will move only when recording.

*1

If the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] or is set to 23.98p, a slight time error may occur when
switching to Playback Mode. (l 161)
≥ It is automatically set to [FREE RUN] in following cases:
j When PRE-REC is enabled (l 95, 183)
j When [2 SLOTS FUNC.] is set to [BACKGROUND] (l 177)
≥ It is automatically set to [REC RUN] in following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode*2 (l 100)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
*2 [FREE RUN] is also available if the number of frames for the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] and
the number of frames for Variable Frame Rate Mode are the same.
Example: When [REC FORMAT] is set to [FHD 1080/29.97p 50M] and the frame rate is set to
[30]
≥ The time code will reset when the built-in lithium battery is exhausted when it is set to
[FREE RUN].

- 79 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

80 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[TC PRESET]
You can set the initial time code.

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [RECORD SETUP] # [TC PRESET]

Touch the item to set and change with

/

.

≥ The value will be set to 00h00m00s00f if you press the RESET button.
≥ “h” is an abbreviation for hour, “m” for minute, “s” for second and “f” for frame.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ This unit will adjust the time code in accordance with the frame rate of the [REC FORMAT]
(l 161). Therefore, it may not be continuous from the previous final time code when the
recording format is changed.
≥ If the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] is set to 23.98p, set the number of frames to [00] or a multiple
of 4. If you enter a different value, time code will not be recorded correctly.

Setting the User Information
Eight digit hexadecimal alphanumeric can be entered and displayed as a memo information such as
dates, control numbers, etc., into the User Information.
UB 00 00 00 00
≥ This is displayed only when [REC MODE] is set to [AVCHD]. (l 160)

[UB PRESET]
You can set the User Information.
≥ Set [REC MODE] to [AVCHD]. (l 160)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [RECORD SETUP] # [UB PRESET]

Touch the item to set and change with

/

.

≥ You can use numbers from 0 to 9 and letters from A to F.
≥ The value will be set to 00 00 00 00 if you press the RESET button.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

- 80 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

81 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Setting the Recording Counter
Recording Counter will display the recording time in seconds.
0:00:00 (hour : minute : second (When [REC COUNTER] is set to [TOTAL]))
SCN 0:00:00 (hour : minute : second (When [REC COUNTER] is set to [SCENE]))

[REC COUNTER]
Select the counting method during the recording.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # [REC COUNTER] # desired setting

[TOTAL]:

The count continues to increase until the Recording Counter is reset.

[SCENE]:

Resets the Recording Counter at start of recording. Counts the time
of each recording session.

To reset the Recording Counter for the Recording Mode
The Recording Counter will be set to 0:00:00 when the RESET button is pressed while displaying
the counter.

- 81 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

82 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

USER button
Each of the USER button can register one function from the 44 available functions.
≥ There are 9 USER buttons (USER1 to 9) on the main body and 4 USER button icons (USER10 to
USER13) displayed on the LCD monitor.

Setting the USER button

1

Select the menu.

MENU

: [USER SW] # [USER1] to [USER13]

≥ It is not possible to register functions to [USER10] to [USER13] in Playback Mode.

2

Touch the item to register.

≥ For the functions of the USER button that can be registered, refer to page 84.
≥ Touch [INHIBIT] if not registering.
≥ Next (Previous) page can be displayed by touching
/
.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ The tables below show the default settings.
USER1 button

[AREA]

USER8 button

[REC CHECK]

USER2 button

[FOCUS MACRO]

USER9 button

[AWB]

USER3 button

[SLOT SEL]

USER10 button

[IR REC]

USER4 button

[WFM]

USER11 button

[BACKLIGHT]

USER5 button

[ZEBRA]

USER12 button

[ATW LOCK]

USER6 button

[O.I.S.]

USER13 button

[MENU]

USER7 button

[LCD/EVF OUTPUT]

≥ Performing [ALL] in [INITIAL SET] restores these default settings. (l 198)

- 82 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

83 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using the USER button
To use the function assigned to a USER button or USER button icon, press the applicable USER
button (one of the USER buttons 1 to 9), or touch the applicable USER button icon (one of the
USER button icons 10 to 13) while operation icons are displayed.
(When you use the USER1 to USER7 button)

(When you use the USER8 button)

LCD/EVF

O.I.S.
6

7

USER
REC CHECK

1

8
2
3
WFM

ZEBRA

4

5

(When you use the USER9 button)

(When you use the USER10 to USER13 button)
[USER10]
[USER11]
[USER12]
[USER13]

AWB
9

≥ To cancel, press the USER button or touch the USER button icon again.
For canceling or using of the following functions for the USER buttons, refer to each page.
j [ZEBRA] (l 97)
j [SCENE FILE] (l 98)
j [AUTO REC] (l 98)
j [AF AREA] (l 99)
j [D.ZOOM] (l 87)
j [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] (l 32)
j [PUSH AUTO] (l 55, 56)
j [AWB] (l 63, 66)

j [BLACK FADE] (l 86)
j [WHITE FADE] (l 86)
j [REC CHECK] (l 88)
j [LAST SCN DEL] (l 88)
j [AREA] (l 90)
j [FOCUS TRANS] (l 61)
j [BACKGROUND] (l 93)
j [WFM] (l 95)

∫ Switch display/not-display of the USER buttons
Display/not-display of the USER button icons in the LCD monitor can be switched.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [USER SW] # [USER BUTTON DISPLAY] # [ON] or [OFF]

∫ Check the setting of the USER buttons
To check the USER button (USER1 to 9) settings on the
recording screen, press and hold the DISP/MODE CHK
button to display the mode information screen. (l 108)
ュリヴヱバ
ヮヰュユチヤラレ

- 83 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

84 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

Functions of the USER button
∫ List of USER button functions
Item
[INHIBIT]

Icon
[INH]

Function
Invalid

[FOCUS ASSIST 1]

[FA1]

Focus Assist 1

[BACKLIGHT]

[B.Light]

Backlight Compensation

[SPOTLIGHT]

[S.Light]

Spotlight

[BLACK FADE]

[B.FD]

Black Fade

[WHITE FADE]

[W.FD]

White Fade

[ATW]

[ATW]

Auto Tracking White Balance

[ATW LOCK]

[ATW.L]

ATW Lock

[D.ZOOM]

[D.ZM]

Digital Zoom

[FOCUS ASSIST 2]

[FA2]

Focus Assist 2

[REC CHECK]

[REC.C]

Recording Check

[LAST SCN DEL]

[LstDel]

Last Scene Delete

[DRS]

[DRS]

DRS

[FRZ FRAME]

[FRZ]

Freeze Frame

[SUPER GAIN]

[S.Gain]

Super Gain*1

[AREA]

[AREA]

Area Mode

[FOCUS TRANS]

[F.Tran]

Focus Transition*2

[PUSH AUTO]

[PushAuto]

Push Auto

[EVF/LCD DETAIL]

[DETAIL]

EVF/LCD detail

[IR REC]

[IR REC]

Infrared Recording

[LEVEL GAUGE]

[Level]

Level Gauge

[BACKGROUND]

[Backgr]

Background

[FLASH BAND]

[FBC]

Flash band compensation

[PRE-REC]

[PRE-REC]

PRE-REC

[WFM]

[WFM]

WFM

[FAST ZOOM]

[F.ZOOM]

Fast Zoom

[EVF ON/OFF]

[EVF SW]

EVF ON/OFF

[A.IRIS LEVEL]

[A.IRIS]

Auto Iris Level

[ZEBRA]

[ZEBRA]

Zebra

[O.I.S.]

[O.I.S.]

Optical Image Stabilizer

[SCENE FILE]

[SCN FILE]

Scene File

[AUTO REC]

[AutoRec]

Auto Rec

*1
*2

Not available in Auto Mode
Not available for Auto Focus

- 84 -

午前11時40分

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

85 ページ

Item
[AF AREA]

2016年11月28日

Icon
[AF Area]

月曜日

Function
AF Area Width adjustment

[VFR]

[VFR]

Variable Frame Rate Mode

[FOCUS MACRO]

[F.Macro]

Focus Macro

[i.ZOOM]

[i.Zoom]

i.Zoom

[USB MODE]

[USB]

USB Mode*3

[AWB]

[AWB]

Auto White Balance

[SUPER SLOW]

[SuperSlow]

Super Slow Recording

[SLOT SEL]

[SlotSel]

Slot Selection

[LCD/EVF OUTPUT]

[LCD/EVF]

LCD/EVF Output

[LOW GAIN]

[LowGain]

Low gain

[MID GAIN]

[MidGain]

Mid gain

[HIGH GAIN]

[HighGain]

High gain

[MENU]

[MENU]

Menu

*3

午前11時40分

Not available during AG ROP application connection.

≥ The USER button function can also be set from the following menu item.
j [DRS] (l 158)
j [O.I.S.] (l 169)
j [EVF/LCD DETAIL] (l 53)
j SCENE FILE: [LOAD/SAVE] (l 152)
j [INFRARED REC] (l 183)
j [i.Zoom] (l 49)
j [LEVEL GAUGE] (l 193)
j [USB MODE] (l 197)
j [FLASH BAND COMPENSATION] (l 166)
j [AF AREA WIDTH] (l 55)
j [PRE-REC] (l 183)
j [VFR MODE] (l 183)
j [WFM] (l 173)
j [FOCUS MACRO] (l 172)
j [FAST ZOOM] (l 49)
j [SUPER SLOW REC] (l 183)
j [AUTO IRIS LEVEL] (l 68)
j [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] (l 32)
j [ZEBRA] (l 173)

[FOCUS ASSIST 1]
≥ Register [FOCUS ASSIST 1] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can set the Focus Assist. (l 56)
≥ You can set the Focus Assist method in [FOCUS ASSIST 1] in the [SW SETUP] menu.

[BACKLIGHT]
≥ Register [BACKLIGHT] to a USER button. (l 82)
Switches to automatic iris control to compensate the backlight.
This makes the image brighter to prevent darkening of a backlit subject.
≥
appears when it is set.
≥ Canceling [BACKLIGHT] resets the iris mode to the previous setting.
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)

- 85 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

86 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[SPOTLIGHT]
≥ Register [SPOTLIGHT] to a USER button. (l 82)
Switches to automatic iris control for spotlight.
Very bright object is recorded clearly.
≥
appears when it is set.
≥ Canceling [SPOTLIGHT] resets the iris mode to the previous setting.
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)

[BLACK FADE]
≥ Register [BLACK FADE] to a USER button. (l 82)
Fade in/fade out effect (black) can be added to the video and audio that is being recorded.
Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
≥ Fade out will start, and fade in will start after completing the fade out.
≥ It will fade out when the button is pressed and held, and fade in will start when the button is
released.
≥ Recording will not start even if the fade out is started. It is possible to press the recording start/
stop button during the fade in or fade out.
≥ Black Fade is not possible in following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ The thumbnails of scenes recorded using fade in become black.

[WHITE FADE]
≥ Register [WHITE FADE] to a USER button. (l 82)
Fade in/fade out effect (white) can be added to the video and audio that is being recorded.
Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
≥ Fade out will start, and fade in will start after completing the fade out.
≥ It will fade out when the button is pressed and held, and fade in will start when the button is
released.
≥ Recording will not start even if the fade out is started. It is possible to press the recording start/
stop button during the fade in or fade out.
≥ White Fade is not possible in following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ The thumbnails of scenes recorded using fade in become white.

- 86 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

87 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[ATW]
≥ Register [ATW] to a USER button. (l 82)
The White Balance can be changed to [ATW]. (l 64)
≥ This function is not available when the White Balance mode is set to [ATW LOCK].

[ATW LOCK]
≥ Register [ATW LOCK] to a USER button. (l 82)
This sets the White Balance mode to [ATW LOCK].(l 65)

[D.ZOOM]
≥ Register [D.ZOOM] to a USER button. (l 82)
Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
≥ When [DIGITAL ZOOM] is set to [k2], [k5] or [k10], Digital Zoom will be turned on/off each time
you press the button.
≥ When [DIGITAL ZOOM] is set to [TOGGLE], the zoom magnification will change each time you
press the button.
2k # 5k # 10k # Setting canceled

∫ To change the zoom magnification of Digital Zoom
The zoom magnification of Digital Zoom varies depending on the [DIGITAL ZOOM] setting.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [DIGITAL ZOOM] # desired setting

[k2]:

Sets the zoom magnification to 2k.

[k5]:

Sets the zoom magnification to 5k.

[k10]:

Sets the zoom magnification to 10k.

[TOGGLE]:

Changes the zoom magnification each time you press the applicable
USER button.

≥ When using Digital Zoom, the larger you set the zoom magnification, the lower the picture quality
becomes.
≥ Digital Zoom is not possible in following cases:
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j When using Area Mode (l 90)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
≥ Digital zoom is canceled in following cases:
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)

- 87 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

88 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[FOCUS ASSIST 2]
≥ Register [FOCUS ASSIST 2] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can set the Focus Assist. (l 56)
≥ You can set the Focus Assist method in [FOCUS ASSIST 2] in the [SW SETUP] menu.
≥ When [FOCUS ASSIST 1] in the [SW SETUP] menu is set to [BOTH], the USER button is
disabled.

[REC CHECK]
≥ Register [REC CHECK] to a USER button. (l 82)
Approximately 2 seconds at the end of the video recorded last can be played back. It will return to
recording screen once the playback is completed.
≥ Playback operation is not possible during the Recording Check.
≥ Recording Check is not possible in following cases:
j When the unit is turned on/off
j When the THUMBNAIL button is pressed
j When the SD card is inserted/removed
j When the setting of [REC FORMAT] is changed (l 161)
j Set [2 SLOTS FUNC.] to [SIMULTANEOUS] or [BACKGROUND]. (l 177)
j PRE-REC is used (l 95, 183)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)

[LAST SCN DEL]
≥ Register [LAST SCN DEL] to a USER button. (l 82)
The motion picture recorded last can be deleted.
Deleted scenes cannot be restored.

1
2

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
Touch [YES].

≥ It will return to recording screen without deleting by touching [NO].
≥ Last Scene Delete is not possible in following cases:
j When the unit is turned on/off
j When the THUMBNAIL button is pressed
j When the SD card is inserted/removed
j When the setting of [REC FORMAT] is changed (l 161)
j Set [2 SLOTS FUNC.] to [SIMULTANEOUS], [BACKGROUND] or [DUAL CODEC]. (l 177)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)

- 88 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

89 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[DRS]
≥ Register [DRS] to a USER button. (l 82)
Selects the DRS (Dynamic Range Stretcher) function.
It is possible to expand the dynamic range by compressing the video signal level of the highly
illuminated area that gets washed out with standard recording.
≥ This item is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ If there are extremely dark or bright parts or the brightness is insufficient, the effect may not be
clear.
≥ It is also possible to adjust the compression level of the highly illuminated area by changing the
[DRS EFFECT] setting. (l 159)

[FRZ FRAME]
≥ Register [FRZ FRAME] to a USER button. (l 82)
Freezes the image on the unit.
≥ Freeze will appear on the screen and flash.
≥ If you record a motion picture during Freeze Frame, the frozen image and sounds will be
recorded.
≥ You can perform the following camera operations during Freeze Frame. Other camera operations
will be disabled.
j Recording motion pictures
j Canceling Freeze Frame
j Operating the FOCUS A/M/¶ switch
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When using Focus Assist (l 56)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
j When color bars are displayed (l 106)
≥ Freeze Frame is canceled if you operate this unit in any of the following ways:
j Turning off the unit
j Pressing the THUMBNAIL button
j Enabling Super Slow Recording.
j Setting this unit to Variable Frame Rate Mode
j Setting [USB MODE SELECT] to [DEVICE] and connecting this unit to a PC (l 133)

[SUPER GAIN]
≥ Register [SUPER GAIN] to a USER button. (l 82)
≥ Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)
This changes the gain value to a [SUPER GAIN] value. (l 70)

- 89 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

90 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[AREA]
You can apply a variety of effects to the subject you touch.

∫ Setting an Area Mode effect
You can select the following menu items to set an effect to be applied when you touch the subject.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [AREA MODE] # desired setting

[INH]:

Does not apply any effects of Area Mode.

[FOCUS]:

Optimizes the focus automatically for the subject you touch.

[IRIS]:

Optimizes the iris automatically for the subject you touch.

[Y GET]:

Displays the luminance level of the subject you touch.

[FOCUS/IRIS]:

Optimizes the focus and iris automatically for the subject you touch.

[FOCUS/Y GET]:

Optimizes the focus automatically for the subject you touch and
displays the luminance level of the subject.

∫ Using Area Mode
≥ Register [AREA] to a USER button. (l 82)

1

Press the applicable USER button or touch the applicable USER button icon
on the recording screen.

≥ Area Mode will be enabled and

2

will be displayed.

Touch the recording screen.

≥ The area frame will be displayed on the part you have
touched. The effect of the selected menu item will be
applied.



To turn off Area Mode
(With a USER button)

Press the USER button
A

Area frame

(With a USER button icon)

1
2

Touch and hold the recording screen to display operation icons.
Touch the USER button icon.

To change the size of the area frame
You can rotate the jog dial to change the size of the
area frame.
≥ The area frame is available in three sizes.

- 90 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

91 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ Area mode is not possible in following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During AG ROP application connection (l 141)
≥ Area mode is canceled in following cases:
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j If you switch to a [REC FORMAT] setting with a frame rate of 24.00p. (l 161)
j When the setting of [ASPECT CONVERT] is changed (l 165)
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC (l 133)
≥ When using Area Mode, even if you set [ZEBRA] to [MARKER], the luminance display frame will
not be displayed. (l 97, 173)
In addition, the luminance level will not be displayed if [AREA MODE] is set to [FOCUS], [IRIS] or
[FOCUS/IRIS].

[FOCUS TRANS]
≥ Register [FOCUS TRANS] to a USER button. (l 82)
≥ Switch to Manual Focus Mode. (l 52)
With Focus Transition, you can move the current focus position to a pre-registered focus position.
(l 60)

[PUSH AUTO]
≥ Register [PUSH AUTO] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can use the USER button as the PUSH AUTO button.
≥ Pressing the USER button or touching the USER button icon in Manual Focus Mode allows you
to use One Push AF. (l 55)
≥ Pressing and holding the USER button or touching and holding the USER button icon in Manual
Focus Mode allows you to use Push AF. (l 56)

[EVF/LCD DETAIL]
≥ Register [EVF/LCD DETAIL] to a USER button. (l 82)
[EVF/LCD DETAIL] helps you achieve focus easier by emphasizing the outlines of an image
displayed on the LCD monitor or the viewfinder. (l 53)
≥ These settings will not affect the images actually recorded.

- 91 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

92 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[IR REC]
≥ Register [IR REC] to a USER button. (l 82)
This changes the Infrared Recording Mode setting.
≥ This unit operates as follows in Infrared Recording Mode:
j
appears on the screen.
j The iris, gain, and shutter speed are adjusted automatically.
j When [AUTO SLOW SHTR] is set to [ON], the shutter speed will be automatically adjusted to
1/30, 1/24 or 1/25. (l 176)
It is recommended to use a tripod.
It takes longer to focus with Auto Focus in dark locations.
Do not use this function in a bright location. Doing so may cause malfunction.
You can record a clear image by positioning the center area of the screen over the subject.
This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ Focus values may not be displayed correctly in Infrared Recording Mode. (l 52)
≥ The following menu items are not available in Infrared Recording Mode:
≥
≥
≥
≥
≥

j [BLACK GAMMA] (l 157)
j [KNEE MODE] (l 158)
j [KNEE MASTER POINT] (l 158)
j [KNEE MASTER SLOPE] (l 158)
j [DRS] (l 89, 158)
j [DRS EFFECT] (l 159)
j [AUTO IRIS LEVEL] (l 68, 97)
j [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT] (l 68)
j [HIGH SENS. MODE] (l 166)
j [ATW TARGET R] (l 65)
j [ATW TARGET B] (l 65)
j [WB VAR] (l 171)
j [MF ASSIST] (l 59)
j [CUSTOM AF] (l 54)
j [AF SPEED] (l 54)
j [AF SENSITIVITY] (l 54)
j [FOCUS TRANSITION] (l 60)

j [FILE SELECT] (l 151)
j [NAME EDIT] (l 152)
j [LOAD/SAVE]
(USER button function: [SCENE FILE])
(l 98, 152)
j [MASTER DETAIL] (l 153)
j [DETAIL CORING] (l 153)
j [SKIN TONE DTL] (l 153)
j [V DETAIL LEVEL] (l 153)
j [RB GAIN CONTROL SETTING] (l 154)
j [CHROMA LEVEL] (l 155)
j [CHROMA PHASE] (l 155)
j [MATRIX] (l 155)
j [COLOR CORRECTION SETTING]
(l 156)
j [MASTER PED] (l 157)
j [GAMMA MODE] (l 157)

≥ The following functions are not available in Infrared Recording Mode:
j Focus Transition (l 61)
j Change the White Balance mode (l 63)
j Iris adjustment (l 67)
j Gain adjustment (l 69)
j AGC Limit (l 70)
j Shutter speed adjustment (l 71)

j ND filter (l 107)
j Backlight Compensation (l 85)
j Spotlight (l 86)
j ATW (l 87)
j ATW Lock (l 65)
j Super Gain (l 70)

≥ It is also possible to change the color in which images are recorded in [IR REC COLOR] (l 184)

- 92 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

93 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[LEVEL GAUGE]
≥ Register [LEVEL GAUGE] to a USER button. (l 82)
This function displays the horizontal/vertical tilt of the unit with the electronic level.

∫ To correct the tilt
(Horizontal direction)

(Vertical direction)




When correcting the leftward tilt

When correcting the downward tilt

≥ The horizontal tilt display A and vertical tilt display B appear yellow when there is a tilt, and
appear green when there is almost no tilt.
≥ The maximum tilt display angles are approximately 45 o in horizontal direction and 10 o in vertical
direction.
≥ The electronic level does not affect the actual recorded images.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j When color bars are displayed (l 106)
≥ If [SELF SHOOT] (l 195) is set to [MIRROR], the electronic level will not be displayed when you
record yourself.
≥ Even when the tilt is in the corrected state, an error of approximately 1 o may occur.
≥ In the following cases, the electronic level may not be displayed correctly:
j When moving this unit
j When pointing this unit up or down at an angle closer to perpendicular

[BACKGROUND]
≥ Register [BACKGROUND] to a USER button. (l 82)
When [2 SLOTS FUNC.] is set to [BACKGROUND], you can start/stop background recording.
≥ When the recording destination of motion pictures is set to [SD CARD 1] in [MEDIA SELECT]
(l 41), [SD CARD 2] will be used for background recording.
The following instructions assume that the recording destination of motion pictures is set to [SD CARD 1].
≥ Set [2 SLOTS FUNC.] to [BACKGROUND]. (l 177)
BACKGR is displayed beside the SD card display for card 2.
(To start background recording)

Press the applicable USER button or the applicable USER button icon.
≥ Background recording will start on the SD card in card slot 2. ( BACKGR will be displayed in red.)
(To stop background recording)

While motion picture recording to [SD CARD 1] is stopped, press and hold the
applicable USER button or the USER button icon.
≥ Please refer to page 179 about Background recording.

- 93 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

94 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[FLASH BAND]
≥ Register [FLASH BAND] to a USER button. (l 82)
If you set this item to [ON], you can compensate for and reduce flash band, a phenomenon that
creates markedly different levels of luminance between the top and bottom of the image when
recording is performed in an environment where another camera is firing its flash.
≥ FBC appears on the screen.

A
B
C
D

Time flow
Image recorded
Flash firing
Flash band

∫ Note on the use of the Flash Band Compensation function
Regardless of whether a flash is fired or not, the Flash Band Compensation function is activated
whenever an external light source drastically changes the brightness of the lower half of the screen.
The function, as a result, may be activated in recording situations such as when you zoom in or out
on a bright window. We recommend using the function in recording situations where flashes are
expected to be fired.
Please note that the Flash Band Compensation function may not produce an adequate effect in
certain recording situations even when a flash is fired.
≥ The phenomena below may occur when a flash is fired. These are caused by the Flash Band
Compensation function and are not malfunctions.
j Moving subjects appear as if they have stopped for an instant
j The resolution deteriorates when a flash is fired.
j Horizontal lines appear in the image when a flash is fired.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] is 29.97p, 23.98p, 24.00p or 25.00p (l 161)
j When using [DIGITAL ZOOM] (l 87)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ The setting will be turned off in the following cases:
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)
≥ The shutter speed will be set to 1/60 or 1/50. It is not possible to adjust the shutter speed.

- 94 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

95 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[PRE-REC]
≥ Register [PRE-REC] to a USER button. (l 82)
This allows the recording of an image and audio to start before you press the recording start/stop
button. AVCHD scenes will be recorded from approximately 3 seconds before the operation, while
MOV/MP4 will be recorded from approximately 4 seconds before the operation.
≥ [P-] is displayed on the screen. After you start recording, the display changes to [P-REC].
≥ Aim the unit at the subject beforehand.
≥ There is no beep sound.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j When [2 SLOTS FUNC.] is set to [BACKGROUND] (l 177)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
≥ In the following cases, a 3 second image that precedes the recording of an AVCHD scene or a
4 second scene that precedes the recording of an MOV/MP4 scene may not be recorded:
j Immediately after the maximum PRE-REC standby time has elapsed*
j If the length of time from when [PRE-REC] is set to [ON] to when you start recording is too short
j If the length of time from when you display the recording screen by turning it off and on or pressing
the THUMBNAIL button to when you start recording is too short since you set PRE-REC
j When the card slot selected for motion picture recording is switched automatically because you
started recording with normal settings or when [2 SLOTS FUNC.] is set to [RELAY REC] (l 41)
* The maximum PRE-REC standby time is 3 hours. Once PRE-REC is activated, it is automatically
deactivated and then re-activated every 3 hours.
≥ Images displayed on the thumbnail in Playback Mode will differ from the motion pictures
displayed at the start of playback.

[WFM]
≥ Register [WFM] to a USER button. (l 82)
This function displays waveforms on the LCD monitor.

Press USER button in the recording screen.
≥ When [WFM TYPE] is set to [WAVE] or [VECTOR], each press of the button enables/disables
WFM.
≥ When [WFM TYPE] is set to [WAVE/VECTOR], each press of the button switches the setting.
WAVE (wave display) # VECTOR (vector display) # OFF
≥ If you have enabled WFM by touching the applicable USER button icon, set [WFM] to [OFF] to
disable it. (l 173)
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When using the viewfinder
j When recording yourself (l 37)
j When using Focus Assist (l 56)

j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j When color bars are displayed. (l 106)

≥ [WFM] will be canceled in the following cases:
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)

- 95 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

96 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ To change the type of WFM
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [WFM TYPE] # desired setting

[WAVE]:

Displays waveforms as waves.

[VECTOR]:

Displays waveforms as vectors.

[WAVE/VECTOR]:

Switches the setting each time the applicable USER button is pressed.

≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When using Focus Assist (l 56)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j When color bars are displayed (l 106)

∫ To change the display position of WFM
Select the menu.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # [WFM POSITION] # desired setting

[TOP/LEFT]/[TOP/RIGHT]/[BOTTOM/LEFT]/[BOTTOM/RIGHT]

≥ You can also change the waveform position to the upper left, upper right, bottom left or bottom
right by performing one of the following operations while a waveform is displayed:
j Rotating the jog dial
j Sliding the waveform while touching it.

[FAST ZOOM]
≥ Register [FAST ZOOM] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can use Fast Zoom when operating the zoom with the zoom lever. (l 49)

[EVF ON/OFF]
≥ Register [EVF ON/OFF] to a USER button. (l 82)
This forces the viewfinder to turn on/off.
≥ After the viewfinder turns on, if the eye sensor detects your eye when it is moved closer to the eye
cup of the viewfinder the [EVF ON/OFF] setting will be canceled.
≥ When the [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] is set to [LCD], this item cannot be set. (l 32)

- 96 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

97 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[A.IRIS LEVEL]
≥ Register [A.IRIS LEVEL] to a USER button. (l 82)
This enables/disables the Auto Iris Level.
≥ When this item is enabled, the [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT] setting is applied. (l 68)

[ZEBRA]
≥ Register [ZEBRA] to a USER button. (l 82)

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
It will switch between the zebra display and the marker display every time the button is pressed.
Zebra 1 # Zebra 2* # Marker* # setting canceled
* It is not displayed when the [ZEBRA DETECT 2]/[MARKER] is set to [OFF]. (l 191)
(When Zebra 1 is set)

(When Marker is set)


99%





Zebra display:
Parts where white saturation (color saturation) is likely to occur (extremely brightly lit or shiny parts)
are displayed with diagonal lines (zebra pattern A).
Marker display:
Displays the luminance level of the center of the screen (luminance display frame B) in %.
It makes the adjustment of the brightness of the object easier, by checking the luminance level of
the object, when recording same object in different surroundings.
≥ Luminance level C is displayed between 0% and 99%. It will be displayed as 99% when it is
over 99%.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When [WFM] is set to [ON] (l 95, 173)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ You can record an image with little white saturation if you manually adjust the shutter speed or
brightness not to display zebra pattern. (l 67, 71)
≥ The zebra pattern does not appear on the images actually recorded.
≥ It is also possible to adjust the level of the zebra pattern to be displayed. (l 191)
≥ It is also possible to change the [ZEBRA MODE] setting to change the display time for the zebra
pattern display. (l 173)

[O.I.S.]
≥ Register [O.I.S.] to a USER button. (l 82)
This enables/disables the Image Stabilizer. (l 50)

- 97 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

98 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[SCENE FILE]
≥ Register [SCENE FILE] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can save the scene file settings to the SD card or load them from the SD card to this unit.

∫ Saving scene file settings
1
2
3

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
Touch [SAVE].
Touch the name of the scene file.

≥ All scene number settings ([F1:] to [F6:]) will be saved.
≥ Up to 8 files can be saved.
≥ If you have touched the name of the existing scene file, touch [YES] to overwrite it.

4

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

∫ Assigning saved scene files to scene numbers
1
2
3
4
5

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.
Touch [LOAD].
Touch the name of the scene file you want to load.
Touch
/
to select the scene number to which you want to assign the
scene file.
Touch [RETURN].

6

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ When you touch [YES], Settings* of the scene number you have selected will be loaded and then
assigned to the corresponding scene number in [FILE SELECT].
* The title of the scene number will also be loaded.
≥ If you select [ALL], settings of all scene numbers will be loaded.

≥ You can also access this function by selecting menu items.
[SCENE FILE] # [LOAD/SAVE] # [LOAD] or [SAVE]

[AUTO REC]
≥ Register [AUTO REC] to a USER button. (l 82)
This enables/disables a function that controls recording performed with an external device
(recorder, etc.) connected to this unit.

1

Select the [REMOTE REC] menu.
MENU

2

Select the [REMOTE REC LINK] menu.
MENU

3

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [REMOTE REC] # [ON]

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [REMOTE REC LINK] # [OFF]

Select the [HDMI TC OUTPUT] menu.
MENU

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [HDMI TC OUTPUT] # [ON]

- 98 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

4

99 ページ

2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.

≥ This will display
and send a signal to the external device instructing it to start recording.
≥ To stop recording to the external device, press the applicable USER button or touch the
applicable USER button icon again. This will display
and send a signal to the external
device instructing it to stop recording.

[AF AREA]
≥ Register [AF AREA] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can adjust the area width where Auto Focus works according to the size of the subject. (l 55)

1

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.

≥ AF-AREA are displayed on the screen.

2

Rotate the jog dial to adjust the AF area
frame.


A
B

3


[AF AREA]
AF area frame

Push the jog dial to finish the adjustment.

≥ Press USER button or touch the USER button icon to cancel the setting.
≥ To adjust the AF area frame again, press the jog dial while the on-screen
icon [
AF AREA] (yellow) is displayed, and repeat Steps 2s3.
≥ For information on on-screen icons, refer to 111.

- 99 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

100 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[VFR]
This enables/disables Variable Frame Rate (VFR) Mode.
In Variable Frame Rate Mode, you can record quick or slow motion picture by changing the frame
rate before recording.
Slow motion (overcrank recording)
Used in scenes such as climaxes, a slow motion effect creates a dramatic impression. Set a frame
rate that provides more frames than the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] does.
Example: If you set [FHD 1080/25.00p 50M] to 50 fps and record a motion picture, a slow motion
effect of 1/2 can be gained.
Quick motion (undercrank recording)
A fast motion effect is used in scenes showing the flow of clouds, people standing in the middle of
crowds, etc. Set a frame rate that provides less frames than the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] does.
Example: If you set [FHD 1080/25.00p 50M] to 12 fps and record a motion picture, a quick motion
effect of 2k (approx.) can be gained.
≥ Register [VFR] to a USER button. (l 82)
≥ Make the [REC MODE] and [REC FORMAT] settings. (l 160, 161)
≥ Variable Frame Rate Mode is available for the following [REC MODE] and [REC FORMAT]
settings.
System frequency setting

Recording mode

Recording format

MOV, MP4

FHD 1080/29.97p 50M,
FHD 1080/23.98p 50M

59.94Hz
50.00Hz

1

FHD 1080/25.00p 50M

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.

≥ [VFR] will be displayed.
≥ The frame rate display will change.
(Example)



12 : 25.00p

A
B

Frame Rate (fps)
Frame rate in [REC FORMAT]



≥ ALC / A.REC will be displayed. Audio is not recorded during recording.

2

Rotate the jog dial to change the frame rate.

≥ You can set a frame rate between 2 and 60 or between 2 and 50. Depending on the
[REC FORMAT] setting, some frame rates are not available.
≥ Push the jog dial to set the frame rate. If you start recording before pushing the jog dial, the
setting will not be applied.

3

Press the recording start/stop button to start recording.

≥ When recording in Variable Frame Rate Mode for the first time since you turned on this unit, a
message is displayed, informing you that audio cannot be recorded.*
* Audio is recorded when the number of frames for the frame rate in [REC FORMAT] and the
number of frames for Variable Frame Rate Mode are the same.
≥ The frame rate cannot be changed during recording.

4

Press the recording start/stop button again to stop recording.

≥ To cancel Variable Frame Rate Mode, press USER button, or touch USER button icon.

- 100 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

101 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Frame rates and their effects
Quick motion (undercrank) or slow motion (overcrank) recording is possible with the following frame
rate settings:
[REC FORMAT]

Available frame rates

[FHD 1080/29.97p 50M]

2 fps to 28 fps

30 fps

32 fps to 60 fps

[FHD 1080/23.98p 50M]

2 fps to 22 fps

24 fps

26 fps to 60 fps

[FHD 1080/25.00p 50M]

2 fps to 23 fps

25 fps

27 fps to 50 fps

Effect on playback

Quick motion
(The smaller the value
is, the faster the
playback becomes.)

Normal

Slow motion
(The larger the value
is, the slower the
playback becomes.)

Audio recording

No

Yes

No

∫ Frame rates during actual recording
There is a slight difference between each frame rate that can be selected and the actual frame rate
at which recording is performed.
Recording will be performed at one of the frame rates below.
≥ Top row: frames rates that can be selected (fps); bottom row: frame rates during actual recording
(fps)
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [59.94Hz])
2
2.00

12
11.99

15
14.99

20
19.98

22
22.48

34
33.72

36
35.96

45
44.96

48
47.95

60
59.94

24
23.98

26
25.69

28
27.97

30
29.97

27
27.50

30
30.00

37
37.50

50
50.00

32
31.97

(When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [50.00Hz])
2
2.08

12
12.50

21
20.83

23
23.08

25
25.00

≥ You can also enable/disable Variable Frame Rate Mode or change the frame rate using the
menu.
j [VFR MODE] (l 183)
j [FRAME RATE] (l 183)
≥ Variable Frame Rate Mode is set to [OFF] in following cases:
j When the [REC MODE] or [REC FORMAT] setting is changed to a setting that does not
support Variable Frame Rate Mode
≥ The following functions are canceled:
j Flash band compensation (l 94, 166)
j Relay recording (l 177)
j Background recording (l 177)
j Interval Recording (l 182)
j PRE-REC (l 95, 183)
j Hybrid Optical Image Stabilizer (l 50)
j Area Mode (l 90)

j Focus Transition (l 60)
j Digital Zoom (l 87)
j Infrared Recording mode (l 92, 183)
j Custom AF function (l 54)
j i.Zoom (l 49)
j Freeze Frame (l 89)
j Super Slow Recording (l 103)

- 101 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

102 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ It is not possible to adjust the shutter speed to a value slower than the limit imposed by the set
frame rate.
Example:
When [REC FORMAT] is set to [FHD 1080/25.00p 50M], if you set the frame rate to 25 fps, the
shutter speed cannot be adjusted to a value slower than 1/25.
≥ [BLACK FADE] and [WHITE FADE] are disabled. (l 86)
≥ Even if you press the recording start/stop button as soon as recording has started, it may take
some time until the recording stops.
≥ The screen may momentarily black out when the frame rate is changed in Step 2.
≥ When using Variable Frame Rate (VFR) Mode with a low frame rate setting, this unit may not be
able to keep up with changes in the image. In such a case, set the iris, focus and White Balance
mode to manual settings.
≥ The maximum continuous recordable time for one scene in Variable Frame Rate Mode varies
depending on the set frame rate. Recording stops when a certain time has elapsed since the start
of the recording, and restarts automatically a few seconds later.
j With undercrank recording: 10 hours
j When recording with the same frame rate as the frame rate in [REC FORMAT]: 10 hours
j With overcrank recording, the recordable time becomes shorter than 10 hours depending on
the ratio between the frame rate for [REC FORMAT] and variable frame rate setting.
Example: When [REC FORMAT] is set to [FHD 1080/25.00p 50M]
Maximum continuous recordable time for
one scene

Variable frame rate setting
2 fps

10 h

25 fps
50 fps

5h

≥ “h” is an abbreviation for hour.

[FOCUS MACRO]
≥ Register [FOCUS MACRO] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can enable/disable Focus Macro.
≥
is displayed on the screen when [ON] is selected.

[i.ZOOM]
≥ Register [i.ZOOM] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can enable/disable i.Zoom. (l 49)

[USB MODE]
≥ Register [USB MODE] to a USER button. (l 82)
Enable/disable connection to the USB ports of this unit.
≥ If you switch the setting from on to off while a USB port is in use, a message may be displayed,
instructing you to unmount the USB cable safely. Select [YES] to terminate the connection safely.

- 102 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

103 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[AWB]
≥ Register [AWB] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can change the White Balance mode or use Auto White Balance or Auto Black Balance. (l 63,
66)

[SUPER SLOW]
This enables/disables Super Slow Recording. You can enable this function to record slow motion
pictures.
≥ Register [SUPER SLOW] to a USER button. (l 82)
≥ Make the [REC MODE] and [REC FORMAT] settings. (l 160, 161)
≥ Super Slow Recording is available for the following [REC MODE] and [REC FORMAT] settings:
System Frequency
setting

Recording mode

59.94Hz

1

FHD 1080/29.97p 50M, FHD 1080/23.98p 50M

MOV, MP4

50.00Hz

Recording format

FHD 1080/25.00p 50M

Press USER button or touch USER button icon in the recording screen.

≥ [SUPER SLOW] will be displayed.
≥ The frame rate display will change.
(Example)



100 : 25.00p

A
B

Frame rate (fps): indicated in blue
Frame rate in [REC FORMAT]



≥ ALC / A.REC will be displayed. Audio is not recorded during recording.

2

Press the recording start/stop button to start recording.

≥ When recording in Super Slow Recording for the first time since you turned on this unit, a message
is displayed, informing you that audio cannot be recorded.

3

Press the recording start/stop button again to stop recording.

≥ To cancel Super Slow Recording, press USER button, or touch USER button icon.

∫ Frame rates and their effects
The slow motion speed during playback varies depending on the frame rate in [REC FORMAT].
Frame rate of [REC FORMAT]
Slow motion speed during playback

29.97p, 25.00p

23.98p

1/4a the normal speed

1/5a the normal speed

≥ This function can also be set from the menu.
[RECORD SETUP] # [SUPER SLOW REC] (l 183)
≥ Super Slow Recording is disabled if any of the following operations is performed:
j Setting [REC MODE] or [REC FORMAT] to a setting not available for Super Slow Recording

- 103 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

104 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ The following functions are canceled:
j Flash band compensation (l 94, 166)
j Relay recording (l 177)
j Background recording (l 177)
j Interval Recording (l 182)
j PRE-REC (l 95, 183)
j Hybrid Optical Image Stabilizer (l 50)
j Area Mode (l 90)

j Focus Transition (l 60)
j Digital Zoom (l 87)
j Infrared Recording mode (l 92, 183)
j Custom AF function (l 54)
j i.Zoom (l 49)
j Freeze Frame (l 89)
j Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)

≥ (When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [59.94Hz])
There is a slight gap between the displayed frame rate for Super Slow Recording and the actual
frame rate at which Super Slow Recording is performed. Although [120] is displayed on the
screen, the actual recording is performed at 119.88 fps.
≥ It is not possible to adjust the shutter speed to a value slower than the limit imposed by the frame
rate used for Super Slow Recording.
(Example) When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [59.94Hz], the shutter speed cannot be adjusted to a
value smaller than 1/120.
≥ [BLACK FADE] and [WHITE FADE] are disabled. (l 86)
≥ Even if you press the recording start/stop button as soon as recording has started, it may take
some time until the recording stops.
≥ The maximum continuous recordable time for one scene in Super Slow Recording varies
depending on the frame rate of [REC FORMAT]. Recording stops when a certain time has
elapsed since the start of the recording, and restarts automatically a few seconds later.
Frame rate of [REC FORMAT]

Maximum continuous recordable time for
one scene

29.97p, 25.00p

2 h 30 min

23.98p

2h

≥ “h” is an abbreviation for hour, “min” for minute and “s” for second.

[SLOT SEL]
≥ Register [SLOT SEL] to a USER button. (l 82)
You can change the card slot used for motion picture recording or the playback media.
≥ You can change the setting in the following situations:
j While recording is paused in Recording Mode
j While a thumbnail screen is displayed in Playback Mode (l 113)
j While the list by date is selected (l 119)

[LCD/EVF OUTPUT]
≥ Register [LCD/EVF OUTPUT] to a USER button. (l 82)
This changes how to turn on/off the LCD monitor and Viewfinder. (l 32)

- 104 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

105 ページ 2016年11月28日

[LOW GAIN]
≥ Register [LOW GAIN] to a USER button. (l 82)
The gain value can be changed to low gain. (l 69)
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)

[MID GAIN]
≥ Register [MID GAIN] to a USER button. (l 82)
The gain value can be changed to middle gain. (l 69)
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)

[HIGH GAIN]
≥ Register [HIGH GAIN] to a USER button. (l 82)
The gain value can be changed to high gain. (l 69)
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)

[MENU]
≥ Register [MENU] to a USER button. (l 82)
The menu can be displayed.

- 105 -

月曜日

午前11時40分

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

106 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Useful functions

ャモンヴ


ュリヴヱバ
ヮヰュユチヤラレ

ワュチョリロヵユン
ヒバプフ



ヒバヒプ



ヒバフ
ヰョョ

A
B
C

BARS button
ND FILTER switch
DISP/MODE CHK button

Color Bar Screen
BARS button
Press the BARS button to output a color bar screen to an external monitor so you can adjust
them.
≥ To cancel, press the BARS button again.
≥ It will be canceled when the unit is turned off.
≥ While color bars are displayed, a test tone will be output from the headphone terminal and a
particular external output terminal. It will not be output from the speaker of this unit.
≥ Different color bars are displayed depending on the [BARS TYPE] setting. (l 173)
≥ The frequency of a test tone that is output when color bars are displayed differs depending on the
setting of the following items:
j [SYSTEM FREQ] (l 160)
j Frame rate in [REC FORMAT] (l 161)
System Frequency
setting

Frame rates

59.94Hz

All frame rates

50.00Hz

24.00p
50.00p/50.00i/25.00p

- 106 -

Test tone
frequency
1 kHz
997 Hz

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

107 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ The test tone volume differs depending on the [TEST TONE] setting. (l 190)
≥ You can record color bars as motion pictures.
≥ If you press the BARS button while recording color bars as a motion picture, you can stop
displaying the color bars. To display them again, stop the recording and press the BARS button.

ND filter
Using the ND filter switch, you can switch the built-in optical ND filter setting. (The filter adjusts the
amount of light.)
≥ Use this function when recording a bright subject outdoors under a clear sky that causes the
screen to look white.

Slide the ND filter switch.
ND1/16
ND1/64



A
B

ND filter setting
Recommended ND filter setting


1/64:

Reduces the amount of light to 1/64.

1/16:

Reduces the amount of light to 1/16.

1/4:

Reduces the amount of light to 1/4.

OFF:

Does not use the ND filter.

≥ If the selected setting 1/64, 1/16 or 1/4 does not match an ND filter setting recommended by this
unit, the recommended setting will be displayed on the screen, blink for approximately 5 seconds
and disappear.
≥ A recommend ND filter setting may not be displayed correctly in scenes that are too dark.

- 107 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

108 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Switching the screen indications/mode information
display
DISP/MODE CHK button
When the DISP/MODE CHK button is pressed, all screen displays disappear, except for the
counter display, time stamp display*, zebra pattern display, marker display, and safety zone
display. (l 203)
* When [DATE/TIME] is set to [TIME], [DATE], or [DATE&TIME]
≥ To cancel the setting, press the DISP/MODE CHK button.

∫ To display the Mode Information
Press and hold the DISP/MODE CHK button to display the mode information screen first. Each time
you press the button, the display mode of the screen switches in the following order:
Mode information display1 # Mode information display2 # Mode information display3 #
Mode information display4 # Mode information display5 # Normal display
Mode information display1: Displays the list of functions assigned to the USER buttons
(USER1 to 9).
Mode information display2: Displays the title given to each scene number of a scene file.
Mode information display3: Displays the settings assigned to the GAIN button ([GAIN L]/
[GAIN M]/[GAIN H]), the White Balance mode settings assigned to
the WHITE BAL button ([WHITE BAL A]/[WHITE BAL B]/[WHITE
BAL PRST]), and the setting status of the White Balance modes
[Ach] and [Bch] ([AWB A]/[AWB B]).
Mode information display4: Displays the settings for [REMOTE REC], [REMOTE REC LINK],
[HDMI TC OUTPUT], [CAMERA NUMBER], [SUB REC BUTTON]
and [SUB ZOOM].
Mode information display5: Displays the settings for [AUDIO LOW CUT CH1], [AUDIO LOW
CUT CH2], [AUDIO LEVEL CH1], [AUDIO LEVEL CH2], [INPUT1
LINE LEVEL], [INPUT2 LINE LEVEL], [INPUT1 MIC LEVEL] and
[INPUT2 MIC LEVEL].

- 108 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

109 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Using Operation Icons
You can use convenient functions just by the easy operation of touching the screen.

1

Touch the LCD monitor in the recording
screen.

≥ The operation icons are displayed.

2

PRE-REC

Touch an operation icon.

ATW.L

≥ The following function is available. Refer to the respective
pages for the operation.
F1: , F2: etc.
DRS

,

PRE-REC

etc.

F1: F2: F3: F4: F5: F6:
DRS

MENU

Scene number of [FILE SELECT] (l 151)
USER Button Icon (l 83)

≥ If you touch the screen while an operation icon is being displayed or do not touch the icon for a
certain period, it will disappear. To display again, touch the screen.

- 109 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

110 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording

Using of jog dial
A

Jog dial


ヴユロバ
ヱヶヴラ
ヴユヵ

Selecting/setting items
You can select and set menu items (l 40), etc. using the jog dial.

1

Rotate the jog dial on the menu screen,
etc., to move the cursor.

≥ The selected item will be displayed in yellow.

2

Push the jog dial to set.

Menu operations for setting a value
When a menu that lets you set a value is displayed, select the value display before adjusting the
setting.
≥ You cannot select
/
/
/
with the jog dial when a screen that lets you adjust a value is
displayed.
(Example: When adjusting the brightness for [LCD SET])

1

Rotate the jog dial to move the cursor to the
value display A.

≥ Push the jog dial to select the value display.

2

Rotate the jog dial to adjust the setting.

≥ Pushing the jog dial will set the value you have selected.


≥ The jog dial also allows you to select/set operation icons, thumbnails, etc.
≥ Parts that are finger-touch sensitive can be operated with the jog dial. (Excluding some functions)

- 110 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

111 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Using the multi manual function
You can select the following functions and adjust their settings using the jog dial.
You can also switch between the functions and adjust their settings.
(When the recording screen is displayed)
On-screen icons

Functions

Settings

GAIN

Gain adjustment (l 69)

Adjusts the gain value.

VAR

VAR adjustment (l 66)

Adjusts the VAR setting of the
White Balance.

AF AREA

AF Area Width Adjustment
(l 55)

Adjusts the size of the AF area
frame.

VFR

Variable Frame Rate (l 100)

Changes the frame rate for
Variable Frame Rate Mode.

SHUTTER

Shutter speed (l 71)

Adjusts the shutter speed.

AREA

Area Mode (l 90)

Changes the area frame setting.

ASSIST

Focus Assist (l 56)

Changes the magnification level of
the magnified display

VOLUME

Headphone Volume Adjustment
(l 112)

Adjusts the headphone volume.

ICONS

Allows you to display/select
operation icons on the
recording screen.

s

(When the playback screen is displayed)
On-screen icons

Functions

VOLUME

Volume adjustment (l 115)

ICONS

Allows you to display/select
operation icons on the playback
screen.

Settings
Adjusts the speaker and
headphone volume during motion
picture playback.
s

To change the function you adjust
1 Change settings in advance so that you can select more than two functions.

- 111 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

112 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ Change settings as follows:
Functions

Settings to be changed in advance

Gain adjustment

Switch to Manual Mode. (l 44)

VAR adjustment

Press the WHITE BAL button and the USER button to which
[AWB] is registered to set the White Balance mode to [VAR].
(l 63)

AF Area Width adjustment

Press the USER button to which [AF AREA] is registered to
enable AF Area Setting Adjustment or set [AF AREA
WIDTH] to [SET] using the menu. (l 55, 99)

Variable Frame Rate

Press the USER button to which [VFR] is registered to
enable Variable Frame Rate Mode or set [VFR MODE] to
[ON] using the menu. (l 100, 183)

Shutter speed

Press the SHUTTER button to enable Manual Shutter Mode.
(l 71)

Area Mode

Press the applicable USER button to enable Area Mode. (l 90)

Focus Assist

Set [FOCUS ASSIST 1] or [FOCUS ASSIST 2] to [EXPAND]
or [BOTH]* and press the FOCUS ASSIST button or the
applicable USER button to set Focus Assist to ON. (l 56)
* This item is only set in [FOCUS ASSIST 1].

Headphone Volume Adjustment

Connect headphones to this unit.

≥ The on-screen icon for the selected function is displayed in white. (Function Execution Mode)
If you have selected [
ICONS], you can rotate the jog dial to select an operation icon.

2

Push the jog dial.

≥ The on-screen icon turns yellow. (Function Selection Mode)

3

Rotate the jog dial to select the function you want to adjust, and press the jog
dial to set the selection.

≥ The on-screen icon for the selected function turns white. (Function Execution Mode)
≥ You can rotate the jog dial to adjust the setting of the selected function.

∫ Headphone Volume Adjustment
Adjust the volume of the headphone while recording.
≥ Set [VOLUME] to [ON]. (l 190)

1
2

Connect headphones to the headphone
terminal.
Rotate the jog dial to adjust the volume.

≥ Actual volume to be recorded does not change.

3

Push the jog dial to finish the adjustment.


A

≥ You can also adjust the volume by touching
/
after the adjustment allows you to exit the setting.

- 112 -

[VOLUME]

in Step 2. Not performing touch operations

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

113 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Playback

Motion picture/Still picture playback
1
2

Set this unit to playback mode. (l 31)



Touch the play mode select icon A.

10

11

12

UHD

UHD

13

14

15

UHD

UHD

UHD

16

17

18

UHD

UHD

UHD

UHD

Media display
The selected media is displayed in yellow.

3

Select the media C you wish to play back.

4

(To set this unit to Motion Picture Playback Mode)



Touch the desired recording mode D and
recording format E for playback.





≥ Recording mode options with recorded scenes are
displayed in green.
≥ The available recording format options differ depending on [SYSTEM FREQ] (l 197) or the
recording mode option you have touched.
≥ Next (Previous) page can be displayed by touching
/
.
≥ Touch [ENTER].
≥ A recording mode icon B will be displayed on the thumbnail display. (
/
/
)
(If you have touched the recording mode option [MOV] or [MP4])
≥ After you have touched a recording format option, one of the following icons will be displayed on
each thumbnail. The icon to be displayed differs depending on the size of recording format.
j 4K : Scenes recorded in 4K (4096k2160)
j UHD : Scenes recorded in UHD (3840k2160)
j FHD : Scenes recorded in FHD (1920k1080)
j DU50 : Scenes recorded as sub recordings with [DUAL CODEC REC] set to [FHD 50Mbps]
(l 177, 181)
j DU8 : Scenes recorded as sub recordings with [DUAL CODEC REC] set to [FHD 8Mbps]
(l 177, 181)
≥ If you touch the recording format option [ALL], all scenes of the same recording mode in the
selected media are displayed.
The thumbnails of scenes with a different system frequency are indicated with
. You can
play them back by changing the [SYSTEM FREQ] setting. (l 197)

- 113 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

114 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ (If you have touched the recording mode option [AVCHD])
After you have touched a recording format option, one of the following icons will be displayed on
each thumbnail.
j PS : Scenes recorded in [PS 1080/59.94p]/[PS 1080/50.00p]
j PH : Scenes recorded in [PH 1080/59.94i]/[PH 1080/23.98p]/[PH 1080/50.00i]
j HA : Scenes recorded in [HA 1080/59.94i]/[HA 1080/50.00i]
j HE : Scenes recorded in [HE 1080/59.94i]/[HE 1080/50.00i]
j PM : Scenes recorded in [PM 720/59.94p]/[PM 720/50.00p]
j SA : Scenes recorded in [SA 480/59.94i]/[SA 576/50.00i]
(To set this unit to Still Picture Playback Mode)

Touch the still picture (JPEG) F.


5

Touch the scene or the still picture to be played
back.

10

6

12

UHD

UHD

14

15

UHD

UHD

UHD

16

17

18

UHD

UHD

UHD

UHD

≥ Next (Previous) page can be displayed by touching
/
.
≥ You can change the playback media by pressing the USER button
to which [SLOT SEL] is registered. (l 82)

11

13

Select the playback operation by touching the operation icon.
G
TC 00:02:30:00

Operation icon

≥ If you touch the screen while an operation icon is being
displayed or do not touch the icon for a certain period, it
will disappear. To display again, touch the screen.


Motion picture playback
1/;:
6:
5:
∫:

Still picture playback

Playback/Pause
Fast rewind playback*
Fast forward playback*
Stops the playback and shows the
thumbnails.

1/;:

2;:
;1:
∫:

Slide show (playback of the still
pictures in numerical order) start/
pause.
Plays back the previous picture.
Plays back the next picture.
Stops the playback and shows the
thumbnails.

* When touched twice, the fast forward/fast rewind speed increases. (Screen display will change to
/
.)

- 114 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

115 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Change the thumbnail display
While the thumbnail is displayed, the thumbnail display changes in
the following order if the zoom lever or the sub zoom lever is
operated to
side or
side.

T
T
W

(

side)

(

W

side)

20 scenes () 9 scenes () 1 scene () Scene information display*
* Detailed information of the scene is displayed when playing back motion pictures. Following
information is displayed.
START TC, START UB, and DURATION are displayed only for AVCHD scenes.
j START TC
j DURATION
j START UB
j REC MODE
j DATE
j FORMAT
j TIME ZONE
≥ If you press the THUMBNAIL button to switch between Recording Mode and Playback Mode, the
thumbnails of 9 scenes will be displayed.
≥ By displaying in 1 scene, recording date and time are displayed when playing back motion
pictures, and recording date and file number when playing back still pictures.

∫ Speaker/Headphone volume adjustment
Operate the volume lever, sub zoom lever or jog dial to adjust the speaker/headphone volume
during Motion Picture Playback Mode.

Adjusting the volume with the volume lever/sub zoom lever
Towards “r”:
Increases the volume

T
T

Towards “s”:
Decreases the volume
A

W



[VOLUME]

Adjusting the volume with the jog dial
B


SEL/
PUSH
SET

- 115 -

Jog dial

W

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

1
2

116 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Push the jog dial while [ VOLUME] is displayed.
Rotate the jog dial to adjust the volume.

C

[VOLUME]


3

Push the jog dial to finish the adjustment.

≥ Sound will be heard only during normal motion picture playback.
≥ If pause play is continued for 5 minutes, the screen returns to the thumbnails.
≥ In the following cases, when you select the desired recording format for playback, this unit will be
restarted to switch the system frequency:
j When you have switched recording format from [4K/24.00p] to a different option.
j When you have switched recording format from an option other than [4K/24.00p] to [4K/24.00p]
≥ If you set recording format to [ALL] and play back a scene, the screen may turn dark momentarily
when it switches to another scene.

Motion picture compatibility
≥ This unit is based on AVCHD Progressive/AVCHD.
≥ Even if the devices used have compatible standards, when playback of video recorded using
another device is performed using this device, or when video recorded using this device is
played back in another device, playback may not proceed normally, or may not be possible.
(Please check compatibility in the instruction manual of your device.)
≥ Motion pictures recorded with devices other than this unit are not supported by this unit.

Still picture compatibility
≥ This unit is compliant with the unified standard DCF (Design rule for Camera File system)
established by JEITA (Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association).
≥ The file format of still pictures supported by this unit is JPEG. (Not all JPEG formatted files
will be played back.)
≥ This unit may degrade or not play back still pictures recorded or created on other products
and other products may degrade or not play back still pictures recorded on this unit.
≥ Depending on the playback device, still pictures may be played back with picture sizes
different from the ones with which they were recorded.

- 116 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

117 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Motion picture playback using operation icon
For details on the basic playback operations, refer to page 113.
Playback operation

Playback display

Operating steps

During Playback

Touch the LCD monitor and slide from right to
left (from left to right) during playback.

Skip playback
(to the start of a
scene)

During Pause

Slow-motion
Playback

During Pause
Frame-by-frame
Playback

During Pause
Direct playback

With the playback paused, continue touching
.
(
is for slow rewind playback.)
Slow-motion Playback is performed continuously
while the display is touched and held.
≥ Normal playback is restored when you touch
.
≥ For slow rewind playback, the intervals
between frames and the display time per frame
vary depending on the type of the scene.
With the playback paused, touch
.
(Touch
to advance the frames one at a
time in the reverse direction.)
≥ Normal playback is restored when you touch
.
≥ For reverse Frame-by-frame Playback, the
intervals between frames vary depending on
the type of the scene.
Touch the direct playback bar A or slide it
while touching.
≥ The playback pauses temporarily and skips to
the position touched or slid to while touching.
≥ (When you touch the bar or slide it while
touching during playback)
Playback will start by releasing your touching or
sliding finger.

≥ Scenes that are large in file size may cause this unit to respond slower to operations performed
by the user or cause certain operations performed by this unit to become slower.

- 117 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

118 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Playback

Useful functions
Creating still picture from motion picture
You can save a frame of a recorded motion picture as a still picture. The picture size with which a
still picture will be recorded differs depending on the picture size of [REC FORMAT] with which the
motion picture was recorded.
Recording format

Aspect ratio

Picture size

17:9

8.8M 4096k2160

[REC FORMAT] setting with a size of
4K (4096k2160)
[REC FORMAT] setting with a size of
UHD (3840k2160)

8.3M 3840k2160

[REC FORMAT] setting with a size of
FHD (1920k1080)
[PS 1080/59.94p]/[PS 1080/50.00p]/
[PH 1080/59.94i]/[PH 1080/23.98p]/
[PH 1080/50.00i]/
[HA 1080/59.94i]/[HA 1080/50.00i]/
[HE 1080/59.94i]/[HE 1080/50.00i]

16:9

[PM 720/59.94p]/[PM 720/50.00p]

2.1 M 1920k1080

0.9M 1280k720

While playing back a motion picture, touch the
at the scene you want to save it as a still
picture.

TC 00:02:30:00

≥ When still pictures are being recorded, the remaining
recordable number of still pictures and the still picture
indication
are displayed.
≥ It is convenient to use Pause, Slow-motion Playback and
Frame-by-frame Playback.
≥ Date the motion picture was recorded will be registered as date of the still picture.

∫ About the screen indications while recording still pictures
/
(White)

Size of still pictures

8.3M

R3000
8.3M

R3000

Card slot selected for still picture
recording (l 196)

(Red)

- 118 -

Remaining number of still pictures
Still picture indication (l 205)

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

119 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ Maximum number of recordable pictures that can be displayed is 9999. If the number of
recordable pictures exceeds 9999, R 9999+ is displayed. The number will not change when the
picture is taken until the number of recordable pictures is 9999 or less.
≥ When playing back a still picture recorded with this unit in the 17:9 aspect, black bands appear on
the top and bottom of the screen.
≥ The 17:9 or 16:9 still pictures recorded using this unit may be cropped at the edges when printed.
So, be sure to check before printing in the store or on your printer.
≥ Please refer to page 225 about approximate number of recordable pictures.

Repeat Playback
Playback of the first scene starts after playback of the last scene finishes.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [VIDEO SETUP] # [REPEAT PLAY] # [ON]

The
indication appears on the full screen views.
≥ All the scenes displayed in the thumbnail will be repeatedly played back.
≥ Repeat Playback cannot be used for the slide show playback of the still pictures. (l 114)

Resuming the previous playback
If playback of a scene was stopped halfway, the playback can be resumed from where it was
stopped.

Select the menu.
MENU

: [VIDEO SETUP] # [RESUME PLAY] # [ON]

If playback of a motion picture is stopped,
scene.

appears on the thumbnail view of the stopped

≥ The memorized resume position is canceled if one of the following operations is performed
([RESUME PLAY] will not be set to [OFF]):
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j Changing the recording mode and recording format for playback in Playback Mode

Playing back scenes or still pictures by date
The scenes or still pictures recorded on the same day can be played back in succession.

1

Touch the date select icon.


A

- 119 -

12

10

11

UHD

UHD

UHD

13

14

15

UHD

UHD

UHD

16

17

18

UHD

UHD

UHD

Date select icon

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

2

120 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Touch the playback date.

≥ The scenes or still pictures recorded on the date selected are displayed as thumbnails.

3

Touch the scenes or still picture to be played back.

≥ Dates cannot be selected while the thumbnail screen for the recording format [ALL] of the
recording mode [MOV]/[MP4] is displayed.
≥ If you press the THUMBNAIL button to switch between Recording Mode and Playback Mode, the
thumbnails of all scenes will be displayed.
≥ In cases such as those described below, scenes and still pictures are grouped separately on the
date list, and –1, –2… may be added after the date:
j When the number of scenes exceeds 99
j When the number of still pictures exceeds 999
j When you change the [REC FORMAT] setting (l 161)
j When you set [REC MODE] to [AVCHD] and set Interval Recording to an option other than
[OFF] (l 182)
j When you set [REC MODE] to [MOV] or [MP4] and change the system frequency (l 160)
j When [NUMBER RESET] is performed (l 198)
≥ Scenes recorded with the following [REC FORMAT] settings are grouped separately on the date
list. A recording format icon will be displayed next to the date.
Recording format

Icon to be displayed

[REC FORMAT] setting with a size of 4K (4096k2160)

≥

4K

[REC FORMAT] setting with a size of UHD (3840k2160)

UHD

[REC FORMAT] setting with a size of FHD (1920k1080)

FHD

Scenes recorded as sub recordings with
[DUAL CODEC REC] set to [FHD 50Mbps] (l 177, 181)

DU50

Scenes recorded as sub recordings with
[DUAL CODEC REC] set to [FHD 8Mbps] (l 177, 181)

DU8

[PS 1080/59.94p]/[PS 1080/50.00p]

PS

[PH 1080/59.94i]/[PH 1080/23.98p]/[PH 1080/50.00i]

PH

[HA 1080/59.94i]/[HA 1080/50.00i]

HA

[HE 1080/59.94i]/[HE 1080/50.00i]

HE

[PM 720/59.94p]/[PM 720/50.00p]

PM

[SA 480/59.94i]/[SA 576/50.00i]

SA

is displayed after the date in the list by date for the still pictures created from the motion
picture. (l 118)

- 120 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

121 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Editing

Deleting scenes/still pictures
Deleted scenes/still pictures cannot be restored, so perform appropriate confirmation of
the contents before proceeding with deletion.
≥ Press the THUMBNAIL button to switch this unit to the Playback Mode. (l 31)

∫ To delete the scene or still picture being played back
Touch
while scenes or still pictures to be
deleted are being played back.

TC 00:02:30:00

∫ To delete scenes or still pictures from the thumbnail display
≥ Switch to the thumbnail display of the scenes or still pictures to delete. (l 113)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

: [VIDEO SETUP] or [PHOTO SETUP] # [DELETE] # desired setting

[ALL SCENES]:
All the scenes or still pictures displayed as thumbnails can be deleted.
(When playing back scenes or still pictures by date, all scenes or still pictures of the selected
date will be deleted.)
[MULTI]:
Multiple scenes or still pictures can be selected and deleted.
[SINGLE]:
Single scene or still picture can be selected and deleted.
≥ Protected scenes/still pictures cannot be deleted.

2

(When [MULTI] is selected in Step 1)

Touch the scene/still picture to be deleted.

≥ When touched, the scene/still picture is selected and the
indication appears on the thumbnail.
Touch the scene/still picture again to cancel the operation.
≥ Up to 99 scenes can be selected to be deleted.
(When [SINGLE] is selected in Step 1)

3

Touch the scene/still picture to be deleted.
(When [MULTI] is selected in Step 1)

Touch [Delete].

≥ To continuously delete other scenes/still pictures, repeat Steps 2-3.

- 121 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

122 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

When you stop deleting halfway:
Touch [CANCEL] or press MENU button while deleting.
≥ The scenes or still pictures that have already been deleted when the deletion is canceled cannot
be restored.

To complete editing:
Touch [Return] or press MENU button.
≥ The following scenes/still pictures cannot be deleted:
j Scenes/still pictures that cannot be played back (the thumbnails are displayed as
)
≥ In case of [ALL SCENES], the deletion may take time if there are many scenes or still pictures.
≥ If you delete scenes recorded on other products or still pictures conforming to DCF standard with
this unit, all the data related to the scenes/still pictures may be deleted.
≥ When still pictures recorded on an SD card by other products are deleted, a still picture (other
than JPEG) that cannot be played back on this unit, may be erased.

Protecting scenes/still pictures
Scenes/still pictures can be protected so that they are not deleted by mistake.
(Even if you protect some scenes/still pictures, formatting the SD card will delete them.)
≥ Press the THUMBNAIL button to switch this unit to the Playback Mode. (l 31)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [VIDEO SETUP] or [PHOTO SETUP] # [SCENE PROTECT]

Touch the scene/still picture to be protected.

≥ When touched, the scene/still picture is selected and the
indication appears on the
thumbnail. Touch the scene/still picture again to cancel the operation.
≥ Touch [Return] to complete the settings.

- 122 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

123 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Editing

Copying between SD cards
Motion pictures or still pictures recorded with this unit can be copied between SD Cards inserted in
this unit.
≥ Copying is not possible if the type of the source SD card (SDHC Memory Card/SDXC Memory
Card) is different from that of the target SD card.

∫ Check the used space of the copy destination
It is possible to check the used space of the SD Card by [MEDIA STATUS]. (l 196)
≥ By displaying in 1 scene, recording date and time can be checked when playing back motion
pictures, and recording date and file number when playing back still pictures.
≥ Depending on the media condition, some remaining capacity of the SD Card may not be used.

Copying

1

Press the THUMBNAIL button to switch this unit to the Playback Mode.

≥ Use a sufficiently charged battery or the AC adaptor.

2

Select the menu.

MENU

: [COPY] # [SELECT COPY]

[

]:

Copies from card 1 to card 2

[

]:

Copies from card 2 to card 1

[

]*:

Copies from card 1 to an external media device

[

]*:

Copies from card 2 to an external media device

* Displayed only when the external media is connected. (l 136)

3

Touch desired items following the screen display.

≥ It will return to the previous step by touching [Return].
≥ (When [SELECT SCENES] is selected)
When touched, the scene/still picture is selected and the
indication appears on the
thumbnail. Touch the scene/still picture again to cancel the operation.
≥ (When [SELECT DATE] is selected)
When touched, the date is selected and surrounded by red. Touch the date again to cancel the
operation.
≥ Up to 99 scenes/still pictures or 99 dates can be set in succession.

4

Touch [EXIT] when the copy complete message is displayed.

≥ The thumbnail view of the copy destination is indicated.

When you stop copying halfway
Touch [CANCEL] while copying.

- 123 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

124 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

If you will delete the motion pictures or still pictures after copying is complete, be sure to
play back the motion pictures or still pictures to check that they have been copied to
correctly before deleting.
≥ Depending on the following conditions, the time it takes for copying may be longer.
j The number of recorded scenes is large.
≥ If some motion pictures or still pictures have already been recorded to the copy destination, then
the same date may be assigned or images may not display by date when the list by date is
selected.
≥ Motion pictures that have been recorded on another device may not be copied. Data recorded on
a PC cannot be copied.
≥ The settings for the copied motion pictures and still pictures will be cleared if the protected motion
pictures or still pictures are copied.
≥ The order in which the scenes or still pictures were copied cannot be changed.

- 124 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

125 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Linking to external devices

Connecting Headphones, a Remote
Control or an External Monitor
Headphones
You can connect headphones (commercially-available) to the headphone output jack (3.5 mm
diameter stereo mini jack).



A

Headphone output jack

≥ Sound is not output from the speaker when headphones are connected.

Remote control
You can connect a remote control (commercially-available) to either of the CAM REMOTE terminals
(FOCUS IRIS or ZOOM S/S).
≥ Connecting a remote control to the FOCUS IRIS terminal (3.5 mm diameter mini jack) allows you
to remotely control the focus and iris.
≥ Connecting a remote control to the ZOOM S/S terminal (2.5 mm diameter super-mini jack) allows
you to remotely control the zoom and start/stop recording.

B
C



FOCUS IRIS terminal
ZOOM S/S terminal


≥ Do not connect any device other than a remote control to the CAM REMOTE terminals. Doing so
may change the image brightness or cause the image to be out of focus.
(When a remote control is connected to the FOCUS IRIS terminal)
≥ Priority for iris adjustment is given to the remote control. It is not possible to adjust the iris with the
iris ring of this unit.
≥ If you switch to Auto Mode when [A.IRIS] is set to [ON], the remote control cannot be used.

- 125 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

126 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

External monitor
You can connect this unit to an external monitor as shown in the figure below.



VIDEO
OUT

CH1
AUDIO OUT
CH2



A HDMI Cable (commercially-available)
B AV cable (commercially-available)
≥ To use an AV cable for external output (l 128)
C External monitor
≥ By connecting this unit to an external monitor that supports 4K motion picture with an HDMI cable
and play back scenes recorded with their size in [REC FORMAT] set to 4K (4096k2160) or UHD
(3840k2160), you can enjoy finely-detailed 4K motion pictures. If 4K motion picture is not
supported on your external monitor, you can change the [RESOLUTION] setting so that 4K
motion pictures can be played back at a lower resolution.
≥ To play back scenes recorded with a [REC FORMAT] setting of [UHD 2160/59.94p 150M] or
[UHD 2160/50.00p 150M], an external monitor that supports 4K/60p (50p) is required.
If 4K/30p (25p) is supported on your external monitor, you can change the
[HDMI UHD OUTPUT LIMIT] setting so that 4K motion pictures can be played back at a lower
output frame rate. (l 189)
≥ If you set [REC FORMAT] to [UHD 2160/59.94p 150M] or [UHD 2160/50.00p 150M] in Recording
Mode and then connect this unit to a 4K-compatible external monitor with an HDMI cable, images
will be output in 3840k2160 when recording is stopped and in 1920k1080 during recording or
PRE-REC. Please note that the image on the screen of this unit and on the external monitor
disappears for a few seconds every time you start or stop recording or every time you switch the
PRE-REC on/off.
These irregularities do not occur when [RESOLUTION] is set to [1080p] or [1080i], which outputs
images in 1920k1080.

- 126 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

127 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

When connecting with an HDMI cable using an HDMI-to-DVI converter, etc., be sure to
connect the HDMI cable to the connector of this unit last.
Connecting the HDMI cable to the connector of this unit first may result in malfunction.
≥ This unit is not compatible with the VIERA Link.
≥ Use a commercially-available High Speed HDMI cable.
If possible, we recommend using a cable with a length of 3 m or less.
≥ If you connect this unit to the external monitor when this unit is set to Recording Mode, a
squealing sound* may be output. Before connecting this unit, set it to Playback Mode.
* The microphone may pick up the sound from the speakers, producing an abnormal sound.

∫ To watch images on an external monitor (4:3) or when both sides of
the images do not appear on the screen
Change the menu setting to display the images correctly. (Check the external monitor setting.)

Select the menu.
MENU

MENU

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [RESOLUTION] # [DOWN CONV.]
: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [DOWN CONV.] # desired setting

[SIDE CROP]:

Outputs images so that they are fit to the height of the external
monitor screen.

[LETTERBOX]:

Outputs images so that they are fit to the width of the external
monitor screen.

[SQUEEZE]:

Outputs an image by compressing it in the horizontal direction to fit it
in the screen.

≥ This item is fixed to [SQUEEZE] in the following cases:
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to a setting with a size of UHD (3840k2160)
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i]
Example of images with a [17:9] or [16:9] aspect ratio on an external monitor (4:3):
[DOWN CONV.] setting
[LETTERBOX]

[SQUEEZE]

≥ When [DOWN CONV.] is set to [SIDE CROP], the sides of an image will be cut off, causing some
icons on the external monitor to be hidden from the external monitor screen.

∫ To display the on-screen information on the external monitor
When the menu setting is changed, the information displayed on the screen (operation icon and
Counter display etc.) can be displayed/not displayed on the external monitor.
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # [VIDEO OUT OSD] # [ON] or [OFF]

- 127 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

128 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ This item is set to [OFF] in the following situations when this unit is in Recording Mode:
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to a setting with a size of 4K (4096k2160) or UHD (3840k2160)
(l 161)
j During auto recording (l 98, 188)

Setting the external output resolution
Change the setting for outputting images to an external monitor or other external device (recorder,
etc.).

Select the [RESOLUTION] menu.
MENU

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [RESOLUTION] # desired setting

[SYSTEM]/[1080p]/[1080i]/[DOWN CONV.]
≥ [SYSTEM] automatically sets the output resolution according to the setting in [REC FORMAT].
If the images are not output on the external device when the setting is [SYSTEM], switch to the
method [1080p], [1080i] or [DOWN CONV.] which enables the images to be displayed on your
external device. (Please read the operating instructions for the external device.)
≥ [DOWN CONV.] outputs images in standard picture quality.
≥ To connect with an AV cable (commercially-available), select [DOWN CONV.].

∫ To use an AV cable for external output
1

Select the [AV OUT] menu.
MENU

2

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [AV OUT] # [ON]

Select the [RESOLUTION] menu.
MENU

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # [RESOLUTION] # [DOWN CONV.]

≥ Images may not be displayed on the external device for several seconds in some cases, such as
when changing between scenes.
≥ When this unit and an external monitor are connected with an AV cable,
scenes with a [REC FORMAT] size of 4K (4096k2160) are not output.
≥ If the size in [REC FORMAT] is set to 4K (4096k2160), [RESOLUTION] cannot be set to [1080i]
or [DOWN CONV.]. If the size in [REC FORMAT] is set to a different value and [RESOLUTION] is
set to [1080i] or [DOWN CONV.]. the [RESOLUTION] setting will change to [SYSTEM].
≥ When [REC FORMAT] is set to [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i], [RESOLUTION] is fixed to
[SYSTEM].
≥ [RESOLUTION] cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)
≥ In the following cases, the video and audio are not output from VIDEO OUT terminal and AUDIO
OUT terminal:
j When an HDMI cable is connected to this unit
j When [RESOLUTION] is set to the settings other than [DOWN CONV.] (excluding when
[REC FORMAT] is set to [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i])

- 128 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

129 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

About external output resolutions
The external output resolution varies depending on the [RESOLUTION] setting and connected
terminal.
≥ When [RESOLUTION] is set to [SYSTEM], the external output resolution varies depending on the
picture size and frame rate in [REC FORMAT].
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [59.94Hz])
Setting
Picture size/Frame
rate
in [REC FORMAT]
4K (4096k2160)/
24.00p
UHD (3840k2160)/
59.94p

UHD (3840k2160)/
29.97p

UHD (3840k2160)/
23.98p

FHD (1920k1080)/
59.94p,
PS 1080/59.94p
FHD (1920k1080)/
59.94i,
PH 1080/59.94i,
HA 1080/59.94i,
HE 1080/59.94i
FHD (1920k1080)/
29.97p
*1

External output resolution
[RESOLUTION]
setting

HDMI OUT terminal

[SYSTEM]

2160/24.00p

[1080p]

1080/24.00p

[SYSTEM]

2160/59.94p*1

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]

2160/29.97p

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]

2160/23.98p

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]

1080/59.94p

[1080p]
[1080i]

VIDEO OUT terminal

s

s
480/59.94i

s
480/59.94i

s
480/59.94i

s

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]

1080/59.94i

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]

1080/29.97p

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

480/59.94i

s
480/59.94i

s
480/59.94i

2160/59.94p of 4:2:0 (8 bit). When recording motion pictures with this unit, 1080/59.94p of
4:2:2 (8 bit) will be set.

- 129 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

130 ページ 2016年11月28日

Setting
Picture size/Frame
rate
in [REC FORMAT]
FHD (1920k1080)/
23.98p,
PH 1080/23.98p

PM 720 (1280k720)/
59.94p
SA 480 (720k480)/
59.94i

月曜日

午前11時40分

External output resolution
[RESOLUTION]
setting

HDMI OUT terminal

VIDEO OUT terminal

[SYSTEM]

1080/23.98p

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]

720/59.94p

[1080p]

1080/59.94p

[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

480/59.94i

[SYSTEM]

480/59.94p

480/59.94i

s
480/59.94i

s

(When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [50.00Hz])
Setting
Picture size/Frame
rate
in [REC FORMAT]
4K (4096k2160)/
24.00p

External output resolution
[RESOLUTION]
setting

HDMI OUT terminal

[SYSTEM]

2160/24.00p

[1080p]

1080/24.00p

[SYSTEM]
UHD (3840k2160)/
50.00p

UHD (3840k2160)/
25.00p

FHD (1920k1080)/
50.00p,
PS 1080/50.00p
FHD (1920k1080)/
50.00i,
PH 1080/50.00i,
HA 1080/50.00i,
HE 1080/50.00i
*2

2160/50.00p

1080/50.00p

[1080i]

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p

[SYSTEM]

2160/25.00p

[1080p]

1080/50.00p

[1080i]

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p
1080/50.00p

[1080p]
[1080i]

s

*2

[1080p]

[SYSTEM]

VIDEO OUT terminal

s
576/50.00i

s
576/50.00i

s

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p

[SYSTEM]

1080/50.00i

[1080p]

1080/50.00p

[1080i]

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p

576/50.00i

s
576/50.00i

2160/50.00p of 4:2:0 (8 bit). When recording motion pictures with this unit, 1080/50.00p of
4:2:2 (8 bit) will be set.

- 130 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

131 ページ 2016年11月28日

Setting
Picture size/Frame
rate
in [REC FORMAT]
FHD (1920k1080)/
25.00p

PM 720 (1280k720)/
50.00p
SA 576 (720k576)/
50.00i

月曜日

午前11時40分

External output resolution
[RESOLUTION]
setting

HDMI OUT terminal

VIDEO OUT terminal

[SYSTEM]

1080/25.00p

[1080p]

1080/50.00p

[1080i]

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p

[SYSTEM]

720/50.00p

[1080p]

1080/50.00p

[1080i]

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p

576/50.00i

[SYSTEM]

576/50.00p

576/50.00i

s
576/50.00i

s

≥ If you set [RESOLUTION] to [SYSTEM], the external output resolution will be set to 1080/59.94p
or 1080/50.00p in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)

External output resolution for still picture playback
The output resolution varies depending on the system frequency.
Setting
[SYSTEM FREQ]

External output resolution
[RESOLUTION]
setting

HDMI OUT terminal

[SYSTEM]
[59.94Hz]

1080/59.94p

[1080p]
[1080i]

1080/59.94i

[DOWN CONV.]

480/59.94p

[SYSTEM]
[50.00Hz]

24.00 Hz*

1080/50.00p

[1080p]

VIDEO OUT terminal

s
480/59.94i

s

[1080i]

1080/50.00i

[DOWN CONV.]

576/50.00p

576/50.00i

1080/24.00p

s

[SYSTEM]
[1080p]

* If you select the recording format option [4K/24.00p] in Playback Mode, the system frequency
setting will change to 24.00 Hz. (l 113)

- 131 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

132 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Linking to external devices

Connecting to a PC
(File transfer/nonlinear editing)
When this device and a computer for editing are connected using a USB 3.0 Cable (commerciallyavailable), image data in the SD card can be transferred.
≥ This unit supports USB 3.0.
≥ Concerning non-linear editing, refer to the instruction manual of your editing software.
≥ Final Cut Pro can be used if you have a Mac computer. (For details on Final Cut Pro, contact
Apple.)
≥ It is impossible to write data to the SD card on this unit from a PC.

Operating environment (mass storage)
≥ Even if the system requirements mentioned in these operating instructions are fulfilled, some PCs
cannot be used.
≥ The USB equipment operates with the driver installed as standard in the OS.

∫ If using Windows
OS

Windows 10 (32 bit/64 bit)
Windows 8.1 (32 bit/64 bit)
Windows 7 (32 bit/64 bit) SP1

CPU

1 GHz or higher
32-bit (k86) or 64-bit (k64) processor

RAM

2 GB or more (64 bit)/1 GB or more (32 bit)

Interface

USB port

Other requirements

Mouse or equivalent pointing device

∫ If using Mac
PC

Mac

OS

macOS v10.12

CPU

Intel Core 2 Duo or better

RAM

2 GB or more

Interface

USB port

Other requirements

Mouse or equivalent pointing device

- 132 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

133 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Connecting to a PC

Micro-B
USB
DEVICE

A USB 3.0 Cable (commercially-available)
≥ Insert the plugs as far as they will go.

1

Connect this unit to the AC adaptor.

≥ Use the AC adaptor to free you from worrying about the battery running down.

2
3

Turn on the unit.
Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [DEVICE].

MENU

4

Set [USB MODE] to [ON].

MENU

5

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [USB MODE SELECT] # [DEVICE]

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [USB MODE] # [ON]

Connect this unit to a PC.

≥ The USB function selection screen will appear.

6

Touch [PC] on the screen of this unit.

≥ This unit is automatically recognized as an external drive of the PC. (l 134)
≥ When you select an option other than [PC], reconnect the USB Cable.
≥ When using the battery, the LCD monitor turns off after about 5 seconds. Touch the screen to turn
the LCD monitor on.
≥ A USB 3.0 cable is not supplied with this unit. Use a commercially-available double-shielded
USB 3.0 cable with a ferrite core.
If possible, we recommend using a cable with a length of 1.5 m or less.
≥ When performing reading/writing between a PC and an SD card, be aware that some SD card
slots built into PCs and some SD card readers are not compatible with the SDHC Memory Card or
SDXC Memory Card.
≥ When using an SDXC Memory Card, check the following support site.
http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html

- 133 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

134 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ To disconnect USB Cable safely
(For Windows)
Select the
icon in task tray displayed on the PC, and then select the model number of
this unit to disconnect the USB cable.
≥ Depending on your PC’s settings, this icon may not be displayed.
(For Mac)
Drag [CAM_SD] disk icon to the [Trash], and then disconnect the USB Cable.
About the screen indication of the unit
≥ Do not disconnect the USB Cable, battery, or AC adaptor while the access lamp is on or card
access icon (
) appears on the unit screen.
≥ If the screen does not change when the unit is operated while connected to a PC, disconnect
the battery and/or AC adaptor, wait approximately 1 minute, reconnect the battery and/or AC
adaptor, wait approximately 1 minute again, and then turn the unit back on. (Data may be
destroyed when above operation is performed while accessing the SD card.)

About the PC display
When the unit is connected to a PC, it is recognized as an external drive.
≥ Removable disk (Example:
) is displayed in [Computer].
Data recorded using AVCHD format has excellent compatibility with computers, due to its file
form; however, it contains not just image and sound data, but also various important information,
and it is associated using a folder structure which is like a figure. If even part of this information is
changed or erased, faults may occur; for example, it may not be possible for the data to be
recognized as AVCHD data, or it may no longer be possible for the SD card to be used in an
AVCHD device.
Data from a computer cannot be written to the SD card of this device.
Example folder structure of a SD card:

CAM_SD
DCIM
100RAQH0



101RARH0



102CDPFS



PRIVATE
AVCHD
AVCHDTN



BDMV



PANA_EXT



The following data will be recorded.
1 MOV format motion picture data
([01000001.MOV], etc.)
2 MP4 format motion picture data
([01010001.MP4], etc.)
3 JPEG format still pictures created from
the motion picture
(Maximum number of recordable
pictures: 999 ([01020001.JPG] etc.))
4 The motion picture thumbnails
5 AVCHD format motion picture files
([00000.MTS] etc.)
6 For management

- 134 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

135 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Folder names for motion picture data recorded in MOV/MP4 format
The fourth to eighth characters of the folder name of a recorded MOV/MP4 scene are determined
by its picture size, frame rate, motion picture format, recording setting and camera number setting.

100RARH0







A
B
C
D
E

Camera number setting (l 166)
Recording setting
Motion picture format
Frame rate
Picture size

(Example) If the folder name is 100RARH0:
Motion picture data that has a picture size of 3840k2160, frame rate of 59.94 fps, and motion
picture format categorized as progressive recording (MP4 and LPCM) is stored.
Picture size

Y: 1920k1080
R: 3840k2160
Q: 4096k2160

Frame rate

A: 59.94 fps
B: 50 fps
C: 29.97 fps

Motion picture
format

J: Interlace recording (MOV, LPCM)
K: Interlace recording (MP4, LPCM)
Q: Progressive recording (MOV, LPCM)
R: Progressive recording (MP4, LPCM)

Recording setting

H: Recordings other than the ones below
D: Sub recordings of dual codec recording (50 Mbps)
E: Sub recordings of dual codec recording (8 Mbps)
P: Main recordings of dual codec recording

Camera number
setting

D: 25 fps
E: 24 fps
F: 23.98 fps

0 to 9: Numbers between 0 and 9 is set in [CAMERA NUMBER SET].
A to G: Numbers between 10 and 16 is set in
[CAMERA NUMBER SET].

≥ Do not delete the SD card’s folders on a PC. Doing so may make the SD card unusable in this
unit.
≥ When data not supported by this unit has been recorded on a PC, it will not be recognized by this
unit.
≥ Always use this unit to format SD cards.

- 135 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

136 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Linking to external devices

Copying/playing back with an external
media device
≥ In these Operating Instructions, “USB hard disk drive” is indicated as “USB HDD”.
If you connect an external media device, such as USB HDD or USB flash memory (commerciallyavailable) to this unit, you can copy motion pictures and still pictures recorded on this unit to an
external media device.
It can also play back the scenes and still pictures copied to the external media device.
≥ This unit supports USB 3.0.
≥ You can copy scenes and still pictures recorded with this unit while maintaining the image quality.
≥ Please read the operating instructions of the external media device for how to use it.

Preparing for copying/playing back
Refer to the following support site for information about an external media device.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/e_cam
(This Site is English only)
When the external media device that requires formatting is connected, a message is displayed.
Follow the instructions on the screen to format it.
Once the external media device has been formatted, all data stored on it will be deleted. The
data cannot be recovered.
This unit formats the external media device in exFAT*.
≥ In the following cases, an external media device cannot be used by connecting it to this unit:
j An external media device with a capacity below 32 GB or above 2 TB
j When an external media device has two or more partitions
j If an external media device is in a format other than FAT32 or exFAT*
j When connected by using a USB hub
* FAT32 is a format used for SDHC memory cards.
exFAT is a format used for SDXC memory cards.
≥ You cannot copy scenes recorded on an SDXC Memory Card to an external media device in
FAT32 format.

USB



HOST

A
B
C

Connect this unit to the USB HDD with USB Cable (supplied with the USB HDD)
USB HDD (commercially-available)
USB flash memory (commercially-available)

- 136 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

1

137 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

(When using USB HDD)

Connect the AC adaptor (supplied with USB HDD) to the USB HDD.

≥ If you are using a bus-powered or portable USB HDD, this unit can supply power to the USB HDD
by USB Cable (supplied with USB HDD).

2

Connect the AC adaptor to this unit.

≥ Use the AC adaptor to free you from worrying about the battery running down.

3
4

Turn on this unit, and press the THUMBNAIL button to switch to Playback
Mode.
Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [HOST].

MENU

5

Set [USB MODE] to [ON].

MENU

6

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [USB MODE SELECT] # [HOST]

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [USB MODE] # [ON]

Connect the external media device to the USB HOST terminal of this unit.

≥ If you use a USB HDD, connect to the USB HDD with the USB Cable supplied with the USB HDD.
≥ It may take several minutes until the connection is completed.

7

Touch the desired item.

[DIFFERENTIAL COPY]:

Copies all scenes and still pictures recorded with
this unit that have not been copied yet. (l 139)

[SELECT COPY]:

Allows you to select desired scenes/still pictures,
and then copy. (l 139)

[Playback from External Media]:

Plays back scenes and still pictures stored in an
external media device on this unit. (l 140)

[Safe Removal]:

Allows you to safely remove this unit and an
external media device.

When the external media device is connected to other devices such as Blu-ray disc
recorder, a message prompting to format the external media device may display. All the
scenes and still pictures recorded on the external media device will be erased if
formatted. Do not format as important data will get erased and it will be impossible to
restore.

- 137 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

138 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Points to check before copying
≥ When using an external media device for the first time, or using an external media device
that has been used with other devices, first run [FORMAT MEDIA].
≥ Before copying, go to [MEDIA STATUS] to check the amount of free space on the external media
device. (l 138)
≥ It may take longer to copy when there are many scenes.
≥ If you copy protected scenes or still pictures, the protection setting of the copied scenes or still
pictures are canceled.
≥ The order in which the scenes were copied cannot be changed.
Before you delete the data on the SD card after copying is complete, be sure to play back
the external media device to check that they have been copied to correctly. (l 140)

∫ Formatting
This is for initializing the external media device.
≥ Please be aware that if a media is formatted then all the data recorded on the media is
erased and cannot be recovered. Back up important data on a PC etc.
≥ Connect this unit to the external media device and touch [Playback from External Media].

Select the menu.
MENU

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [FORMAT MEDIA] # [EXTERNAL]

≥ When formatting is complete, touch [EXIT] to exit the message screen.
≥ Connect this unit and the external media device to format.
You may no longer be able to use the external media device if you format them on another device
such as a PC etc.
≥ This unit formats the external media device in exFAT.

∫ Displaying media information
The used space of the external media device can be checked.
≥ Connect this unit to the external media device and touch [Playback from External Media].

Select the menu.
MENU

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # [MEDIA STATUS]

≥ If you touch [CHANGE MEDIA], you can switch the display between the SD card 1, SD card 2,
and the external media device.

- 138 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

139 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Copy once

1
2

Connect this unit to the external media device to prepare for copying. (l 136)
Touch [DIFFERENTIAL COPY].

≥ You can also access this function by selecting menu items.
[COPY] # [DIFFERENTIAL COPY]

3
4
5

Touch the media you want to copy.
Touch [YES].
Touch [EXIT] when the copy complete message is displayed.

≥ The thumbnail view of the copy destination is indicated.

When you stop copying halfway:
Touch [CANCEL] while copying.

Copy selected files

1
2

Connect this unit to the external media device to prepare for copying. (l 136)
Touch [SELECT COPY].

≥ You can also access this function by selecting menu items.
[COPY] # [SELECT COPY]

3

Touch the media you want to copy.

[

]:

When copying from the SD card 1 to the external media device.

[

]:

When copying from the SD card 2 to the external media device.

≥ For information on copying between SD cards, refer to page 123.

4

Touch the desired items following the instructions on the screen.

≥ It will return to the previous step by touching [Return].
≥ (When [SELECT SCENES] is selected)
When touched, the scene/still picture is selected and the
indication appears on the
thumbnail. Touch the scene/still picture again to cancel the operation.
≥ (When [SELECT DATE] is selected)
When touched, the date is selected and surrounded by red. Touch the date again to cancel the
operation.
≥ Up to 99 scenes/ 99 dates can be selected continuously.

5

Touch [EXIT] when the copy complete message is displayed.

≥ The thumbnail view of the copy destination is indicated.

When you stop copying halfway:
Touch [CANCEL] while copying.

- 139 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

140 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Playing back the External Media
≥ Only motion picture/still picture that have been copied by connecting this unit to the
external media device can be played back.



USB

HOST

A
B
C

1

USB Cable (supplied with USB HDD)
USB HDD (commercially-available)
USB flash memory (commercially-available)

Connect this unit to the external media device to prepare for playback.
(l 136)

≥ When playing back on an external monitor, connect this unit to the external monitor. (l 126)

2
3

Touch [Playback from External Media].
Touch the scene or still picture to be played back and then play it back.

≥ The playback operation is performed the same as when playing back motion pictures or still
pictures. (l 114, 117)

To terminate the connection between this unit and the external media device
Touch the play mode select icon (l 113) and then touch

.
ヮヱフ

≥ Disconnect the USB Cable from this unit.

≥ It is also possible to switch the media to play back by touching the play mode select icon.
When the external media device is connected, the
(external media device) can be selected
from the displayed media types. (l 113)
≥ In the following cases, when you have touched a play mode select icon and selected the
recording format for playback, this unit will be restarted to change the system frequency. After the
restart, perform Step 2.
j When you have switched recording format from [4K/24.00p] to a different option.
j When you have switched recording format from an option other than [4K/24.00p] to [4K/24.00p]
≥ Deleting scenes and still pictures on the external media device may take time.
≥ You cannot set the [SCENE PROTECT] during playback of
(external media device). (l 122)

- 140 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

141 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Linking to external devices

Using an iPad as a Remote Control
(AG ROP application)
Attaching a wireless module that support this unit (l 142) to the USB HOST terminal of this unit
allows you to connect to a wireless LAN network. You can remotely control some functions by
connecting this unit and an iPad on which the AG ROP application is installed.

USB


HOST

A
B
C
D

Wireless module that support this unit
Direct connection
Wireless access point connection
iPad and AG ROP application

You can perform the following remote control operations with the AG ROP application:
≥ Checking the camera status
≥ Checking the thumbnails of the recorded scenes
≥ Playing back scenes recorded as sub recordings with [DUAL CODEC REC] set to [FHD 8Mbps]
≥ Controlling the camera remotely (recording control and Time Code/User Information operations)
≥ For information on how to operate the AG ROP application, refer to its Help.
≥ You can store a wireless module in the hand strap.

- 141 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

142 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Before connection
iPad/AG ROP application
Install the AG ROP application on the iPad.
≥ Download the AG ROP application from the App Store.
≥ Supported OS for the AG ROP application: iOS 7.1 or later (as of November 2016)

Wireless module
Attach a wireless module that support this unit (AJ-WM50, AJ-WM30: optional*1) to the USB HOST
terminal of this unit.
*1 It may not be available in some countries.

∫ Notes on the use of a Panasonic wireless module
(AJ-WM50/AJ-WM30: optional)
Before use, carefully read the manual of the wireless module carefully to fully understand its
content. The following limitations apply to prevent accidental operations:
(AJ-WM50)
≥ Supported standard: IEEE802.11a/b/g/n/ac
≥ Communication frequency (AJ-WM50P):
2412 MHz to 2462 MHz (1ch, 6ch, 11ch)*2
5250 MHz to 5330 MHz (36ch, 40ch, 44ch, 48ch, 149ch, 153ch, 157ch, 161ch, 165ch)
≥ Communication frequency (AJ-WM50E):
2412 MHz to 2462 MHz (1ch, 6ch, 11ch)*2
5250 MHz to 5330 MHz (36ch, 40ch, 44ch, 48ch)
(AJ-WM30)
≥ Supported standard: IEEE802.11g/n
IEEE802.11a and IEEE802.11b cannot be used.
≥ Communication frequency:
2412 MHz to 2462 MHz (1ch, 6ch, 11ch)*2
*2

12ch and higher cannot be used.

For overseas use
The products below are available to comply with the laws and regulations governing radio waves in
every region of the world.
The products can be used only in the country or region where they are supported.
(AJ-WM50)
Model number

Compatible countries and regions

AJ-WM50P

United States of America

AJ-WM50E

EU member nations

- 142 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

143 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

(AJ-WM30)
Model number

Compatible countries and regions

AJ-WM30MC

People’s Republic of China

AJ-WM30P

United States, Canada, Mexico, Argentina, Peru, Taiwan

AJ-WM30E

EU countries, EFTA countries, Australia, New Zealand, Russia, Ukraine,
Saudi Arabia, United Arab Emirates, Kuwait, Oman, Egypt, Republic of
South Africa, South Korea, Philippines, Malaysia, Singapore

AJ-WM30

Japan

≥ Outdoor use is prohibited in France.

Settings to be made on this unit
To connect an iPad to this unit via wireless LAN, the following information on this unit is required:
j User account name
j Password
j IP address
≥ If you set [DHCP] in [Wireless LAN setup] to [SERVER] and connect to a network, you are not
required to set the IP address.
≥ The user account and password can be set in [USER ACCOUNT].
≥ The IP address can be set in [Wireless LAN setup]. (l 145)

∫ Setting the user account name and password
1

Select the menu.
MENU

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [USER ACCOUNT]

2
3

Touch [SET].
Select and touch an item that has not been registered.

4

Touch [Refresh].

≥ Touch [DELETE] to clear the selected user account.

5

Enter a user account name.

≥ Enter a maximum of 31 characters.
≥ After entering the title, touch [Enter].

- 143 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

144 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Entering text
Operate in the same way as you enter characters with a keyboard.
Icon

Description of operation

[A-a]

Switches between uppercase and lowercase.

[Return]
[

]
[

]

[BS]

/
[Enter]

6

Returns to the previous screen. The entered characters are
canceled.
Switches to symbols and numbers.
Enters a space.
Deletes a character.
Deletes the previous character if the cursor is in an empty space.
Moves the cursor to left or right.
Ends text entry.

Enter a password.

≥ Enter between 6 and 15 characters.
≥ When the entry is complete, touch [Enter].

7

Re-enter the password.

≥ When the entry is complete, touch [Enter].

8

Touch [RETURN].

≥ Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.
≥ The default setting is [OFF] with a user account name of [guest] and a password of [agguest].
≥ Apply the set user account name and password to [AG ROP] in [Settings] on the iPad. For details,
refer to [CONNECTION] in Help of the AG ROP app.

- 144 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

145 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Configuring the wireless LAN settings (IP address, etc.)
1

Select the menu.
MENU

2

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [Wireless LAN setup]

Touch and set the desired items as needed.
≥ All default settings are indicated with underlined text.

[IP Address]:

Enter the IP address.
≥ The default setting is [192.168.0.1].

[Subnet Mask]:

Enter the subnet mask.
≥ The default setting is [255.255.255.0].

[Gateway]:

Enter the gateway.
≥ The default setting is [192.168.0.254].

[DHCP]:

[OFF]:

Disables automatic retrieval by DHCP and the DHCP
server function.

[CLIENT]:

Performs automatic retrieval by DHCP when connecting
with [WIRELESS SETUP] set to [SSID(SELECT)] or
[SSID(MANUAL)].

[SERVER]:

Enables the DHCP server function when connecting with
[WIRELESS SETUP] set to [DIRECT].

[MAC Address]: Displays the MAC address.
≥ If you make a connection with [WIRELESS SETUP] set to [DIRECT], the [Gateway] setting will be
disabled.
≥ [IP Address], [Subnet Mask], and [Gateway] cannot be set when [DHCP] is set to [CLIENT].
≥ [MAC Address] cannot be changed.
≥ For details on how to enter characters, refer to page 144.

3

Touch [EXIT].

≥ A connection cannot be made unless the combination of the IP address, subnet mask, and
gateway are correct.
≥ When not using the gateway, set it to [0.0.0.0].
≥ When [DHCP] is set to [OFF] or [CLIENT], apply the [IP Address] setting to [AG ROP] in
[Settings] on the iPad. For details, refer to [CONNECTION] in Help of the AG ROP app.

- 145 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

146 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Connecting this unit and an iPad
≥ Change the mode to Recording Mode. (l 31)
If you switch to Recording Mode while this unit is connected in Playback Mode, the connection may
be terminated to restart this unit. We recommend setting this unit to Recording Mode before making
a connection.

∫ Settings to be made on the iPad
For information on the settings to be made on the iPad, refer to [CONNECTION] in Help of the AG
ROP app.

∫ Icons to be displayed during connection
Wireless LAN connection:
connected/
not connected
≥ The display will change as follows according to the radio
wave intensity:
(Weak) #
#
#
(Strong).
AG ROP application connection:
connected
≥ The display will change as follows according to the radio
wave intensity:
(Weak) #
#
#
(Strong).

Connecting directly
Configure the settings in this section to directly connect this unit and the iPad.
≥ Attach a wireless module that support this unit to the USB HOST terminal of this unit.
(l 142)
≥ Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [HOST]. (l 197)
≥ Set [USB MODE] to [ON]. (l 197)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [WIRELESS SETUP] # [DIRECT]

Touch and set the desired items as needed.
≥ All default settings are indicated with underlined text.

[SSID]:

Enter the network name (SSID) for this unit.

[BAND]:

Select the frequency band to be used.
[2.4GHz]/[5GHz]

[CHANNEL (2.4GHz)]:

Sets the channel to be used for 2.4 GHz.
[AUTO]/[CH1]/[CH6]/[CH11]

[CHANNEL (5GHz)]:

Sets the channel to be used for 5 GHz.
[AUTO]/[CH36]/[CH40]/[CH44]/[CH48]/[CH149]/[CH153]/[CH157]/
[CH161]/[CH165]

[Password]:

Sets the password.
≥ The default setting is [01234567890123456789abcdef].

- 146 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

147 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ When [DIRECT] is selected, [SECURITY TYPE] is fixed to [WPA2-AES].
≥ Some settings in [BAND], [CHANNEL (2.4GHz)] and [CHANNEL (5GHz)] cannot be selected
depending on the wireless module used.
≥ For details on how to enter characters, refer to page 144.

3
4

Touch [RETURN].
Set [DHCP] to [SERVER].

MENU

5
6
7
8

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [Wireless LAN setup] # [DHCP] # [SERVER]

Touch [EXIT].
Select the SSID of this unit from the Wi-Fi® setup of the iPad.
Enter the password into the iPad.
Check the network connection.

≥ When this unit is ready to be connected,
will be displayed on its screen.
≥ To terminate the connection, after terminating the connection on the iPad side, set [USB MODE]
to [OFF].

Connecting to a wireless access point
Configure the settings in this section to connect this unit and an iPad using a wireless access point.

∫ Searching for wireless access points to set up a connection
≥ Attach a wireless module that support this unit to the USB HOST terminal of this unit.
(l 142)
≥ Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [HOST]. (l 197)
≥ Set [USB MODE] to [ON]. (l 197)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [WIRELESS SETUP] # [SSID(SELECT)]

Touch the wireless access point to connect to.

≥ The SSIDs of wireless access points found with the search will be displayed.
≥ If you touch [Refresh], you can search for wireless access points again.

3

Touch [ENTER].

≥ If an encryption key (password) is not set, the setup is complete.

4

(If an encryption key (password) is set)

Enter the password.

≥ For details on how to enter characters, refer to page 144.
≥ When the connection is complete, touch [Enter].

5

Check the network connection.

≥ When the connection is complete,
is displayed on the screen of this unit.
≥ To terminate the connection, after terminating the connection on the iPad side, set [USB MODE]
to [OFF].

- 147 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

148 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ [SSID(SELECT)] is available only when [USB MODE] is set to [ON], [USB MODE SELECT] is set
to [HOST] and a wireless module that supports this unit is attached.
≥ Depending on your environment, the communication speed may become slower or the wireless
access point may not be available for use.
≥ When [DHCP] in [Wireless LAN setup] is set to [OFF] or [CLIENT], apply the [IP Address] setting
to [AG ROP] in [Settings] (l 145) on the iPad. For details, refer to [CONNECTION] in Help of the
AG ROP app.

∫ Setting up a connection manually
≥ Attach a wireless module that support this unit to the USB HOST terminal of this unit.
(l 142)
≥ Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [HOST]. (l 197)
≥ Set [USB MODE] to [ON]. (l 197)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [WIRELESS SETUP]# [SSID(MANUAL)]

Touch and set the desired items as needed.
≥ All default settings are indicated with underlined text.

[SSID]:

Enter the SSID for the wireless access point to connect to.
≥ This item is not set by default.

[SECURITY TYPE]:

Set the network authentication and encryption types.
[WPA2-AES]/[WPA-AES]/[WPA2-TKIP]/[WPA-TKIP]/[NONE]

[Password]:

Enter the password for the wireless access point to be connected.
≥ This item is not set by default.
≥ This item is not available when [SECURITY TYPE] is set to [NONE].

≥ When [SSID(MANUAL)] is selected, [BAND] is fixed to [2.4GHz], and [CHANNEL (2.4GHz)] and
[CHANNEL (5GHz)] are fixed to [AUTO].
≥ For details on how to enter characters, refer to page 144.

3
4

Touch [EXIT].
Check the network connection.

≥ When the connection is complete,
is displayed on the screen of this unit.
≥ To terminate the connection, after terminating the connection on the iPad side, set [USB MODE]
to [OFF].
≥ Depending on your environment, the communication speed may become slower or the wireless
access point may not be available for use.
≥ When [DHCP] in [Wireless LAN setup] is set to [OFF] or [CLIENT], apply the [IP Address] setting
to [AG ROP] in [Settings] (l 145) on the iPad. For details, refer to [CONNECTION] in Help of the
AG ROP app.

- 148 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

149 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Connecting from History
Connections made to wireless access points are saved in History. Connecting from History allows
you to easily connect with the same settings as used previously.
≥ Attach a wireless module that support this unit to the USB HOST terminal of this unit.
(l 142)
≥ Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [HOST]. (l 197)
≥ Set [USB MODE] to [ON]. (l 197)

1

Select the menu.

MENU

2

: [NETWORK SETUP] # [CONNECTION HISTORY]

Touch the item you want to connect to.

≥ Connection records in History will be displayed as SSIDs of wireless access points.
≥ Touch [DELETE] to clear the selected history data.

3
4

Touch [EXIT].
Check the network connection.

≥ When the connection is complete,
is displayed on the screen of this unit.
≥ To terminate the connection, after terminating the AG ROP application connection, set [USB
MODE] to [OFF].
≥ Up to 20 most recently used connections can be stored in History.
≥ [CONNECTION HISTORY] is available only when [USB MODE] is set to [ON], [USB MODE
SELECT] is set to [HOST] and a wireless module that supports this unit is attached.

- 149 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

150 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Operations during AG ROP application connection
∫ Operations with this unit during connection
≥ The following buttons are disabled:
j SHUTTER button
j GAIN button
j WHITE BAL button
j MENU button (The applicable USER button is also disabled, making it impossible to operate
the menu.)
j BARS button
j THUMBNAIL button
≥ You can change the [ZOOM/FOCUS] setting in the [SW SETUP] menu to switch between
operating this unit and operating it with the AG ROP application. Since selecting [IP REMOTE]
will disable the following switches and buttons, to operate them with this unit, select [CAMERA]:
j Focus ring
j Zoom lever
j Sub zoom lever
j PUSH AUTO button, USER button to which [PUSH AUTO] is registered.
j FOCUS A/M/¶ switch
j Switching to Auto Focus Mode with the AUTO/MANU switch (l 44)
≥ You can press the IRIS button to switch between operating the iris ring of this unit and operating it
with the AG ROP application. The iris ring of this unit cannot be used when you operate this unit
with the AG ROP application.

∫ Recording and playback operations during connection
You can perform operations with either this unit or the AG ROP application while connected to the
AG ROP application.

∫ Limitations on this unit during connection
≥ The following functions are disabled during AG ROP application connection:
j Magnifying the Focus Assist display (l 56)
j Focus Transition (l 61)
j USB Mode (USER button) (l 85)
j Area Mode (l 90)
≥ Settings that are changed remotely with the AG ROP application are applied to the corresponding
settings of this unit.
≥ When WARNING is flashing on the AG ROP application screen, remote control operations may
not be performed due to an error on this unit. Check this unit. For details, refer to “Warning
Indications” on page 212.

- 150 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

151 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Menu

Using the Menu
Refer to page 40 for how to set up the Menu.

Scene file
Settings that are assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] by default are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [SCENE FILE] # desired setting

[FILE SELECT]
You can save the desired image settings to each scene number. Switch the scene number in
accordance with the recording conditions.
[F1:]/[F2:FLUO]/[F3:SPARK]/[F4:STILL]/[F5:CINE V]/[F6:CINE D]

1
2

Touch [FILE SELECT].
Touch
/
to select the scene number.

≥ Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.
3 (To change the image settings)

Change the setting of [SCENE FILE] menu.
≥ You can save the settings of the following menu items to the scene number you have selected.
(l 152 to 159)
j [SYNCHRO SCAN]
j [MASTER DETAIL]
j [DETAIL CORING]
j [SKIN TONE DTL]
j [V DETAIL LEVEL]
j [RB GAIN CONTROL SETTING]
j [CHROMA LEVEL]
j [CHROMA PHASE]
j [MATRIX]
j [COLOR CORRECTION SETTING]
j [MASTER PED]

j [GAMMA MODE]
j [BLACK GAMMA]
j [KNEE MODE]
j [KNEE MASTER POINT]
j [KNEE MASTER SLOPE]
j [DRS]
j [DRS EFFECT]
j [AUTO IRIS LEVEL]
j [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT]
j [NR CONTROL]

Default scene number settings
[F1:]
[F2:FLUO]
[F3:SPARK]
[F4:STILL]
[F5:CINE V]
[F6:CINE D]

Setting appropriate for standard recording
Setting appropriate for recording considering the characteristic of fluorescent lamps
(indoors, etc.)
Setting appropriate for recording with modulation in resolution, color shade, and contrast
Setting which allows you to use a scene file with a picture tone similar to that
produced with a digital still camera.
Setting appropriate for recording as a cinema with high contrast
Setting appropriate for recording as a cinema with high dynamic range

- 151 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

152 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ This function’s default setting is [F1:].
≥ It is possible to switch the scene number by touching F1: to F6: while displaying the operation
icons. (l 109)
≥ You can rename the titles for scene numbers (FLUO, etc.) in [NAME EDIT].
≥ It will return to the default settings when [SCENE] is selected in [INITIAL SET]. (l 198)

[NAME EDIT]
You can rename the title of the scene number selected in [FILE SELECT].

1
2

Touch [NAME EDIT].
Enter the desired title.

≥ For information on how to enter characters, refer to page 144.
≥ Up to 6 alphanumeric characters can be entered.
≥ Touch [Return] to return to the previous screen. (The title will not be renamed to the one that has
been entered.)

3

Touch [Enter].

≥ The title will be updated.

[LOAD/SAVE]
You can save the scene file settings to the SD card or load them from the SD card to this unit.
(l 98)
[LOAD]/[SAVE]

[SYNCHRO SCAN]
Sets the initial Synchro Scan setting.
≥ Depending on the size and frame rate in [REC FORMAT], the setting range varies. (l 161)

1
2
3

Touch [SYNCHRO SCAN].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.
Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

∫ Note on the [SYNCHRO SCAN] setting
A separate [SYNCHRO SCAN] setting is maintained for each size and frame rate in
[REC FORMAT].
≥ Default settings are indicated with underlined text.
Frame rates

[SYNCHRO SCAN] setting

59.94p/59.94i

1/60.0 to 1/249.7

29.97p

1/30.0 to 1/60.0 to 1/249.7

23.98p

1/24.0 to 1/48.0 to 1/249.6

24.00p

1/24.0 to 1/48.0 to 1/249.9

50.00p/50.00i

1/50.0 to 1/250.0

25.00p

1/25.0 to 1/50.0 to 1/250.0

- 152 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

153 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[MASTER DETAIL]
Adjusts the degree of overall outline correction in images.

1
2

Touch [MASTER DETAIL].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s31 and r31.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

[DETAIL CORING]
Adjusts the detail noise removal level.

1
2

Touch [DETAIL CORING].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 0 and 60.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “1”.

[SKIN TONE DTL]
This makes skin colors appear softer for a more attractive appearance.
This is more effective if you record a person closely from the torso up.
[ON]/[OFF]

1
2
3

Touch [SKIN TONE DTL].
Touch [ON].
Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ If the background or anything else in the scene has colors similar to the skin color, they will also
be smoothed.
≥ If the brightness is insufficient, the effect may not be clear.
≥ If you record a person in the distance, the face may not be recorded clearly. In this case, set
[SKIN TONE DTL] to [OFF] or zoom in on the face (close-up) to record.

[V DETAIL LEVEL]
Adjusts the degree of vertical outline correction in images.

1
2

Touch [V DETAIL LEVEL].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s7 and r7.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

- 153 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

154 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[RB GAIN CONTROL SETTING]
This adjusts the color balance for [Ach] or [Bch] of the White Balance mode. You can also set
whether or not to apply the color balance settings to Auto White Balance/Auto Black Balance.

1

Touch [RB GAIN CONTROL SETTING], and select the desired item.

[AWB A]:

Setting for the White Balance mode [Ach]

[AWB B]:

Setting for the White Balance mode [Bch]

2

Touch the desired setting item.

[R GAIN]:

Adjusts the intensity of red.

[B GAIN]:

Adjusts the intensity of blue.

[GAIN OFFSET]:

Sets whether to maintain or reset the [R GAIN] and [B GAIN] settings
when Auto White Balance/Auto Black Balance is used.

3

(If you have touched [R GAIN]/[B GAIN] in Step 2)

Touch

/

to adjust the color balance.

≥ You can select a value between s30 and r30.
≥ Touch [RETURN].
(If you have touched [GAIN OFFSET] in Step 2)

Touch [ON] or [OFF].
[ON]:

Maintains the [R GAIN] and [B GAIN] settings when Auto White Balance/Auto
Black Balance is used.

[OFF]:

Resets the [R GAIN] and [B GAIN] settings when Auto White Balance/Auto Black
Balance is used.

≥ To make additional changes, repeat Steps 2s3.

4

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default settings that are assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] are as follows:
j [R GAIN]: “0”
j [B GAIN]: “0”
j [GAIN OFFSET]: [OFF]

- 154 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

155 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[CHROMA LEVEL]
Adjusts color density.

1
2

Touch [CHROMA LEVEL].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s70 and r30.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

[CHROMA PHASE]
Adjusts color balance.

1
2

Touch [CHROMA PHASE].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s31 and r31.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

[MATRIX]
Represents the color during the recording.

1
2

Touch [MATRIX].
Touch
/
to select the setting item.

[NORM1]:

Suitable for recording in the open air or under a halogen lamp.

[NORM2]:

Suitable for brighter colors than the [NORM1] mode.

[FLUO]:

Suitable for recording indoors under fluorescent lamp.

[CINE-LIKE]:

Suitable for cinema-like image.

[STILL-LIKE]:

Expresses colors in a picture tone similar to that produced with a digital
still camera.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

- 155 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

156 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[COLOR CORRECTION SETTING]
This function sets color saturation and phase. It applies individual effect on 16 phases in an image.
It can be set to individual color hue.
R-Mg
R

90°

112.5°

Mg
67.5°

YI-R-R

Mg-Mg-B

135°

45°

YI-YI-R

Mg-B-B

157.5°

22.5°


Yl

0°
180°

B



202.5°

337.5°

B-B-Cy

G-YI-YI

225°

A

315°

B-Cy-Cy

G-G-YI
247.5°

G

B

292.5°

270°

Cy

[PHASE]
adjustment
[SAT]
adjustment

Cy-G

1
2

Touch [COLOR CORRECTION SETTING].
Touch the phase you want to set.

[R]/[R-Mg]/[Mg]/[Mg-Mg-B]/[Mg-B-B]/[B]/[B-B-Cy]/[B-Cy-Cy]/[Cy]/[Cy-G]/[G]/[G-G-Yl]/
[G-Yl-Yl]/[Yl]/[Yl-Yl-R]/[Yl-R-R]
≥ Next (Previous) page can be displayed by touching
3 (To adjust the saturation)

/

.

Touch [SAT].
(To adjust the phase)

4

Touch [PHASE].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s63 and r63.
≥ (If you have touched [PHASE])
Making adjustments in the + direction corresponds to making adjustments clockwise in the
diagram above. Conversely, making adjustments in the j direction corresponds to making
adjustments counterclockwise in the diagram.

5

Touch [RETURN].

≥ Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

- 156 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

157 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ By default the following values are set for [F1:] in [FILE SELECT]
j SAT: “0”
j PHASE: “0”

[MASTER PED]
Adjustment of black level based on the image is performed.

1
2

Touch [MASTER PED].
Touch
/
to adjust the black level.

≥ You can select a value between s150 and r150.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

[GAMMA MODE]
Tone or contrast of the image is set in accordance with the recorded scenes.

1
2

Touch [GAMMA MODE].
Touch
/
to select the setting item.

[HD]:

This is the video gamma feature for HD (High Definition).

[SD]:

This increases gain in darker areas more than [HD] does.

[FILMLIKE1]:

This feature reproduces highlight areas more than [HD] does.

[FILMLIKE2]:

This feature reproduces highlight areas more than [FILMLIKE1] does.

[FILMLIKE3]:

This feature reproduces highlight areas more than [FILMLIKE2] does.

[CINE-LIKE V]:

This gamma feature creates cinematic images with sharper contrast.

[CINE-LIKE D]:

This gamma feature creates cinematic images.

[STILL-LIKE]:

Expresses colors in a picture tone similar to that produced with a digital
still camera.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ When [CINE-LIKE V] or [CINE-LIKE D] is selected, we recommend that you set the lens aperture
to a level lower than the normal lens iris level (approximately 1/2) to fully utilize the feature of the
selected setting.

[BLACK GAMMA]
This sets the gamma curve of dark areas.

1
2

Touch [BLACK GAMMA].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s8 and r8.
≥ Making adjustments in the – direction compresses dark areas, while making adjustments in the +
direction expands them.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

- 157 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

158 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[KNEE MODE]
To avoid overexposure, select the compression level of the high intensity video signals received
through the image sensor.

1
2

Touch [KNEE MODE].
Touch
/
to select the setting item.

[AUTO]:

Sets the level automatically according to the signals received.

[MANUAL]:

Applies the [KNEE MASTER POINT] and [KNEE MASTER SLOPE]
settings.

[OFF]:

Disables the Knee function.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

[KNEE MASTER POINT]
This adjusts the knee point position in 0.5% steps when [KNEE MODE] is set to [MANUAL].

1
2

Touch [KNEE MASTER POINT].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 80.0 and 107.0.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “93.0”.

[KNEE MASTER SLOPE]
This sets the knee inclination when [KNEE MODE] is set to [MANUAL].

1
2

Touch [KNEE MASTER SLOPE].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 0 and 99.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “85”.

[DRS]
Selects the DRS (Dynamic Range Stretcher) function. (l 89)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 158 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

159 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[DRS EFFECT]
Selects the level of the DRS function.

1
2

Touch [DRS EFFECT].
Touch
/
to select the setting item.

[1]/[2]/[3]
≥ Higher the value, greater the compression level of the highly illuminated area.
≥ Higher the value, greater the noise of the dark area.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ This item is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)

[AUTO IRIS LEVEL]
This enables/disables Auto Iris Level. (l 68)
[ON]/[OFF]

[AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT]
Adjusting brightness during the Auto Iris Mode. (l 68)

1
2

Touch [AUTO IRIS LEVEL EFFECT].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s50 and r50.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

[NR CONTROL]
You can control the noise reduction effect and afterimage intensity by adjusting the noise reduction
setting.

1
2

Touch [NR CONTROL].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between s7 and r7.
≥ Adjusting the setting in the minus (s) direction weakens the noise reduction effect, thereby
reducing afterimages. Note that this also tends to increase noise.
≥ Adjusting the setting in the plus (r) direction enhances the noise reduction effect, thereby
reducing noise. Note that this may also cause afterimages to appear more frequently.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ The default setting that is assigned to [F1:] in [FILE SELECT] is “0”.

- 159 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

160 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

System mode
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [SYSTEM MODE] # desired setting

[SYSTEM FREQ]
Set the system frequency of this unit.
[59.94Hz]:

System frequency for regions where the TV broadcasting system is
NTSC

[50.00Hz]:

System frequency for regions where the TV broadcasting system is PAL

≥ After you have changed the system frequency, this unit will be restarted automatically.
≥ By default, the system frequency is set to the broadcasting system of the region where this
product was purchased.
≥ When recording with [REC MODE] set to [AVCHD], you cannot record scenes of different system
frequencies into a single SD card. Use a different SD card for each system frequency.

[REC MODE]
Switch the recording mode of the motion pictures to record.
[MOV]*:

This recording method is suitable for editing images. Motion pictures will
be saved in MOV format.

[MP4]*:

This recording method is suitable for editing images. Motion pictures will
be saved in MP4 format.

[AVCHD]:

This recording method is suitable for playback on a high-definition
compatible external monitor.

* It is not compatible with motion pictures recorded in AVCHD.
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame (l 89)

- 160 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

161 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[REC FORMAT]
Switch the picture quality of motion pictures to be recorded with this unit.
Depending on the settings of [SYSTEM FREQ] (l 160) and [REC MODE], the available
[REC FORMAT] settings differ.

How to read a [REC FORMAT] setting
Items that make up a [REC FORMAT] setting represent Size, Vertical resolution, Frame rate,
and Bit rate. (Excluding the [REC FORMAT] settings that are available when [REC MODE] is set
to [AVCHD])


A
B

UHD 2160 / 50.00p 150M

Size
Vertical resolution




C
D

Frame rate
Bit rate

≥ Smoother motion picture can be recorded with the higher value for the frame rate. [i] and [p] of
the frame rate means interlace and progressive respectively.
Interlace (interlacing scanning)
Video signal that divides the effective scanning lines to half and send them alternatively
Progressive (progressive scanning)
High density video signal sending the effective scanning lines simultaneously (It will be higher
quality image than the interlace.)
≥ The higher the bit rate value is, the higher the picture quality becomes, except for when the
recording format is
(This exception is due to a difference in compression method).
≥ It can record with highest quality image in this unit when set to [UHD 2160/59.94p 150M] or
[UHD 2160/50.00p 150M].
≥ When the recording format is
, recording is performed with ALL-Intra. ALL-Intra is a
compression method that compresses each frame. This method results in larger file sizes, but
it can minimize the deterioration in picture quality that occurs during editing.
≥ Depending on the [REC MODE] setting and the bit rate of the [REC FORMAT] setting, its
required Speed Class of the SD card differs. Use an SD card that meets the settings. For
details, refer to “About the Speed Class ratings for recording motion pictures” on page 29.

- 161 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

162 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ When [MOV] or [MP4] in [REC MODE] is selected
System frequency
Size
Frame rate
setting
(Picture size)

Recording format

[59.94Hz]/
[50.00Hz]

[4K 2160/24.00p 100M]

4K
(4096k2160)

[UHD 2160/59.94p 150M]
UHD
(3840k2160)

[UHD 2160/29.97p 100M]
[UHD 2160/23.98p 100M]
[FHD 1080/59.94p

24.00p

Average 100 Mbps

59.94p

Average 150 Mbps

29.97p
23.98p

]
[59.94Hz]

[FHD 1080/29.97p

]

[FHD 1080/23.98p

]

FHD
(1920k1080)

23.98p
29.97p

[FHD 1080/23.98p 50M]

23.98p

[FHD 1080/59.94i 50M]

59.94i

[UHD 2160/50.00p 150M]

UHD
(3840k2160)

[UHD 2160/25.00p 100M]

50.00p
25.00p

]

[FHD 1080/50.00p 100M]
[FHD 1080/25.00p

Average 200 Mbps

Average 50 Mbps
Average 150 Mbps
Average 100 Mbps
Average 200 Mbps

50.00p

[50.00Hz]

[FHD 1080/50.00p 50M]

Average 100 Mbps
Average 50 Mbps

29.97p

[FHD 1080/29.97p 50M]

[FHD 1080/50.00p

Average 100 Mbps
Average 200 Mbps

59.94p

[FHD 1080/59.94p 100M]
[FHD 1080/59.94p 50M]

Bit rate (VBR)

Average 50 Mbps

FHD
(1920k1080)

]

25.00p

[FHD 1080/25.00p 50M]
[FHD 1080/50.00i 50M]

Average 100 Mbps

50.00i

Average 200 Mbps
Average 50 Mbps

≥ When [AVCHD] in [REC MODE] is selected
Recording
format

System frequency
setting

Picture size

[PS 1080/59.94p]
[PH 1080/59.94i]

1920k1080

[PH 1080/23.98p]
[HA 1080/59.94i]

[59.94Hz]

Frame rate

Bit rate (VBR)

59.94p

Average 25 Mbps

59.94i
23.98p
59.94i

Average 21 Mbps
Average 17 Mbps

[HE 1080/59.94i]

1440k1080

[PM 720/59.94p]

1280k720

59.94p

Average 8 Mbps

[SA 480/59.94i]

720k480

59.94i

Average 9 Mbps

- 162 -

Average 5 Mbps

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

Recording
format

163 ページ 2016年11月28日

System frequency
setting

Picture size

[PS 1080/50.00p]
[HA 1080/50.00i]

[50.00Hz]

[HE 1080/50.00i]

午前11時40分

Frame rate

Bit rate (VBR)

50.00p

Average 25 Mbps

1920k1080

[PH 1080/50.00i]

月曜日

Average 21 Mbps
50.00i

Average 17 Mbps

1440k1080

Average 5 Mbps

[PM 720/50.00p]

1280k720

50.00p

Average 8 Mbps

[SA 576/50.00i]

720k576

50.00i

Average 9 Mbps

≥ Recordable time using the battery (l 26)
≥ The system frequency is set to 24.00 Hz when [REC FORMAT] is set to a setting with a frame
rate of 24.00p.
≥ The default setting for [REC MODE] is [MP4], and the default setting for [REC FORMAT] is [UHD
2160/50.00p 150M].
≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ Please refer to page 223 about approximate recordable time.
≥ When any of the following [REC FORMAT] settings is selected, the angle of view will change.
j [4K 2160/24.00p 100M]
≥ When the unit is moved a lot or moved quickly, or when a fast-moving subject is recorded,
mosaic-type noise may appear at playback. (Only when recording AVCHD scenes)
≥ In the following cases, this unit will be restarted to switch the system frequency:
j When you change the [REC FORMAT] setting from a setting with a frame rate of 24.00p to a
setting with a different frame rate
j When you change the [REC FORMAT] setting from a setting with a frame rate other than
24.00p to a setting with a frame rate of 24.00p

About recording formats and recording functions
The relationship between recording formats and recording functions of this unit are shown below.
≥ “±”: Available; “s”: Not available*
* “Not available” includes instances where the desired function cannot be used or selected.

Recording function
Normal
recording

Interval Rec
(l 182)

Super Slow
Recording
(l 103, 183),
VFR Mode
(l 100, 183)

[4K 2160/
24.00p
100M]

±

±

s

±

s

s

[UHD 2160/
59.94p
150M]

±

s

s

±

s

s

[UHD 2160/
50.00p 150M]

±

s

s

±

s

s

[UHD 2160/
29.97p 100M]

±

±

s

±

s

±

Recording
format

- 163 -

Relay recording
(l 177),
Simultaneous
recording
(l 177)

Background
recording
(l 177)

Dual codec
recording
(l 177)

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

164 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording function
Normal
recording

Interval Rec
(l 182)

Super Slow
Recording
(l 103, 183),
VFR Mode
(l 100, 183)

[UHD 2160/
25.00p 100M]

±

±

s

±

s

±

[UHD 2160/
23.98p 100M]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
59.94p
]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
50.00p
]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
29.97p
]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
25.00p
]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
23.98p
]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
59.94p 100M]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
50.00p 100M]

±

s

s

±

s

±

[FHD 1080/
59.94p 50M]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[FHD 1080/
50.00p 50M]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[FHD 1080/
29.97p 50M]

±

±

±

±

±

s

[FHD 1080/
25.00p 50M]

±

±

±

±

±

s

[FHD 1080/
23.98p 50M]

±

s

±

±

±

s

[FHD 1080/
59.94i 50M]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[FHD 1080/
50.00i 50M]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[PS 1080/
59.94p]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[PS 1080/
50.00p]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[PH 1080/
59.94i]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[PH 1080/
50.00i]

±

s

s

±

±

s

Recording
format

- 164 -

Relay recording
(l 177),
Simultaneous
recording
(l 177)

Background
recording
(l 177)

Dual codec
recording
(l 177)

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

165 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording function
Normal
recording

Interval Rec
(l 182)

Super Slow
Recording
(l 103, 183),
VFR Mode
(l 100, 183)

[PH 1080/
23.98p]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[HA 1080/
59.94i]

±

±

s

±

±

s

[HA 1080/
50.00i]

±

±

s

±

±

s

[HE 1080/
59.94i]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[HE 1080/
50.00i]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[PM 720/
59.94p]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[PM 720/
50.00p]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[SA 480/
59.94i]

±

s

s

±

±

s

[SA 576/
50.00i]

±

s

s

±

±

s

Recording
format

Relay recording
(l 177),
Simultaneous
recording
(l 177)

Background
recording
(l 177)

Dual codec
recording
(l 177)

[ASPECT CONVERT]
This sets the aspect ratio of images to be recorded with a [REC FORMAT] setting of [SA 480/59.94i]
or [SA 576/50.00i].
≥ Set [REC FORMAT] to [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i]. (l 161)
[SIDE CROP]:

Records images in standard 4:3 mode. The sides will be cut off.

[SQUEEZE]:

Records images by compressing images in the horizontal direction. When
recorded images are played back on a wide-screen external monitor, they
appear in the 16:9 aspect ratio.

≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to an option other than [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i] (l 161)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)

[EXTENDED SENSITIVITY]
Setting this item to [ON] allows you to set a negative gain value. (l 69)
≥ Set [HIGH SENS. MODE] is to [NORMAL]. (l 166)
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ When this item is set to [ON], [EX.SENS.] is displayed on the screen.

- 165 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

166 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[HIGH SENS. MODE]
This sets the optimal recording mode for the recording environment.
[NORMAL]:

Select this setting when the light level of the recording environment is
normal.

[HIGH SENS.]:

Select this setting when recording in a dark environment.

≥ [H.SENS] is displayed on the screen when [HIGH SENS.] is selected.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
≥ [EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] will be set to [OFF] when [HIGH SENS.] is selected.

[FLASH BAND COMPENSATION]
If you set this item to [ON], you can compensate for and reduce flash band, a phenomenon that
creates markedly different levels of luminance between the top and bottom of the image when
recording is performed in an environment where another camera is firing its flash. (l 94)
[ON]/[OFF]

[CAMERA NUMBER SET]
This sets the camera number for this unit.

1
2

Touch [CAMERA NUMBER SET].
Touch
/
to change the Camera Number.

≥ Numbers between 0 and 16 can be set.

3

Touch [RETURN].

≥ Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.
≥ This function’s default setting is “0”.

- 166 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

167 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

User switch
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [USER SW] # desired setting

[USER1]/[USER2]/[USER3]/[USER4]/
[USER5]/[USER6]/[USER7]/[USER8]/[USER9]
Sets the function to assign to the USER buttons. (l 82)
≥ For the functions of the USER button that can be registered, refer to page 84.
≥ The default settings are as follows:
j USER1: [AREA]
j USER2: [FOCUS MACRO]
j USER3: [SLOT SEL]
j USER4: [WFM]
j USER5: [ZEBRA]

j USER6: [O.I.S.]
j USER7: [LCD/EVF OUTPUT]
j USER8: [REC CHECK]
j USER9: [AWB]

[USER10]/[USER11]/[USER12]/[USER13]
Register functions to USER button icons. (l 82)
≥ For the functions of the USER button that can be registered, refer to page 84.
≥ The default settings are as follows:
j USER10: [IR REC]
j USER11: [BACKLIGHT]

j USER12: [ATW LOCK]
j USER13: [MENU]

[USER BUTTON DISPLAY]
Switches the display of the set USER button icons. (l 83)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 167 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

168 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Switch setting
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [SW SETUP] # desired setting

[IRIS RING]
Sets the rotation direction and iris control of the iris ring.
A

[DOWN OPEN]:

Iris will open when it is turned toward B.

[UP OPEN]:

Iris will open when it is turned toward A.

B

1

Iris ring


[LOW GAIN]
Sets the gain value to be used when you switch to [LOW GAIN] by pressing the GAIN button.

1
2

Touch [LOW GAIN].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select [AUTO] or a value between 0 dB and 24 dB.
When [EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] is set to [ON], you can set a value between -3 dB and 24 dB.
(l 165)

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ This function’s default setting is “0 dB”.
≥ When a negative gain value (a value between -3 dB and -1 dB) is selected, if you set
[EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] to [OFF] and operate the GAIN button, the gain value will be set to
0 dB. However, the [LOW GAIN] setting will be maintained.

[MID GAIN]
Sets the gain value to be used when you switch to [MID GAIN] by pressing the GAIN button.

1
2

Touch [MID GAIN].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select [AUTO] or a value between 0 dB and 24 dB.
When [EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] is set to [ON], you can set a value between -3 dB and 24 dB.
(l 165)

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ This function’s default setting is “6 dB”.
≥ When a negative gain value (a value between -3 dB and -1 dB) is selected, if you set
[EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] to [OFF] and operate the GAIN button, the gain value will be set to
0 dB. However, the [MID GAIN] setting will be maintained.

- 168 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

169 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[HIGH GAIN]
Sets the gain value to be used when you switch to [HIGH GAIN] by pressing the GAIN button.

1
2

Touch [HIGH GAIN].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select [AUTO] or a value between 0 dB and 24 dB.
When [EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] is set to [ON], you can set a value between -3 dB and 24 dB.
(l 165)

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ This function’s default setting is “12 dB”.
≥ When a negative gain value (a value between -3 dB and -1 dB) is selected, if you set
[EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] to [OFF] and operate the GAIN button, the gain value will be set to
0 dB. However, the [HIGH GAIN] setting will be maintained.

[SUPER GAIN]
Sets the gain value for the USER button function [SUPER GAIN]. (l 70)
[30 dB]/[36 dB]

[O.I.S.]
This enables/disables the Image Stabilizer. (l 50)
[ON]/[OFF]

[HYBRID O.I.S.]
You can set the Hybrid Optical Image Stabilizer. (l 50)
[ON]/[OFF]

[CUSTOM O.I.S.]
When [ON] is selected, the Image Stabilizer works with customized [BLUR AMPLITUDE] and
[BLUR FREQUENCY] settings. (l 50)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 169 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

170 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[BLUR AMPLITUDE]
This sets the blur amplitude of the Image Stabilizer during recording. (l 50)
[1]/[2]/[3]/[4]/[5]

[BLUR FREQUENCY]
This sets the blur frequency of the Image Stabilizer. (l 50)
[1]/[2]/[3]

[ATW SET]
When you press the WHITE BAL button, you can assign ATW.
[OFF]:

Does not assign ATW when the WHITE BAL button is pressed.

[Ach]:

Sets the White Balance mode to ATW when the WHITE BAL button is pressed to
switch to [Ach].

[Bch]:

Sets the White Balance mode to ATW when the WHITE BAL button is pressed to
switch to [Bch].

[PRST]:

Sets the White Balance mode to ATW when the WHITE BAL button is pressed to
switch to [PRST].

[ATW TARGET R]
This fine-adjusts the intensity of red. (l 65)
≥ This function’s default setting is “0”.

[ATW TARGET B]
This fine-adjusts the intensity of blue. (l 65)
≥ This function’s default setting is “0”.

[WB PRESET]
Sets which White Balance mode to use when the WHITE BAL button is pressed to switch to the
PRST position.
[3200K]/[5600K]/[VAR]

- 170 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

171 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[WB VAR]
Sets the color temperature when the White Balance mode is set to [VAR]. (l 66)

1
2

Touch [WB VAR].
Touch
/
to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 2000K and 15000K.

3

Touch [EXIT] to exit the menu screen.

≥ This function’s default setting is “3200K”.

[MF ASSIST]
When [ON] is selected, focus is automatically adjusted after you adjust it with the focus ring in
Manual Focus Mode. (l 59)
[ON]/[OFF]

[FOCUS ASSIST 1]
Sets the Focus Assist method for the FOCUS ASSIST button and the USER button to which
[FOCUS ASSIST 1] is registered. (l 56)
[EXPAND]/[PEAKING]/[BOTH]

[FOCUS ASSIST 2]
Sets the Focus Assist method for the USER button to which [FOCUS ASSIST 2] is registered.
(l 56)
This item is not available when [FOCUS ASSIST 1] is set to [BOTH].
≥ Set [FOCUS ASSIST 1] to [EXPAND] or [PEAKING]
[EXPAND]/[PEAKING]

[PEAKING COLOUR]
You can set the peaking color for Focus Assist. (l 58)
[Red]/[Blue]/[Yellow]/[White]

[PEAKING LEVEL]
You can set the peaking strength for Focus Assist. (l 58)
≥ This function’s default setting is “0”.

- 171 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

172 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[FOCUS RING DRIVE]
This sets the way you adjust focus with the focus ring. (l 53)
[SPEED]/[COARSE]/[FINE]

[FOCUS MACRO]
This enables/disables the Focus Macro function.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ If [ON] is selected, subjects at a distance of approximately 10 cm to infinity can be brought into
focus when the zoom position is at the W end. (l 48)

[AREA MODE]
You can set an Area Mode effect. (l 90)
[INH]/[FOCUS]/[IRIS]/[Y GET]/[FOCUS/IRIS]/[FOCUS/Y GET]

[CUSTOM AF]
When [ON] is selected, Auto Focus works with customized [AF SPEED] and [AF SENSITIVITY]
settings. (l 54)
[ON]/[OFF]

[AF SPEED]
You can adjust the focus speed of Auto Focus. (l 54)
≥ This function’s default setting is “0”.

[AF SENSITIVITY]
You can adjust the tracking sensitivity of Auto Focus. (l 54)
≥ This function’s default setting is “5”.

[AF AREA WIDTH]
You can adjust the effective area width for Auto Focus according to the size of the subject. (l 55)
[SET]/[OFF]

- 172 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

173 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[WFM]
This enables/disables the Wave Form Monitor function. (l 95)
[ON]/[OFF]

[WFM TYPE]
This sets the type of Wave Form Monitor. (l 96)
[WAVE]/[VECTOR]/[WAVE/VECTOR]

[WFM POSITION]
This sets the display positions of Wave Form Monitor. (l 96)
[TOP/LEFT]/[TOP/RIGHT]/[BOTTOM/LEFT]/[BOTTOM/RIGHT]

[ZEBRA]
Switch between the zebra display and marker display.
[ZEBRA 1]/[ZEBRA 2]*/[MARKER]*/[OFF]
* Not displayed when [ZEBRA DETECT 2]/[MARKER] is set to [OFF]. (l 191)
≥ For information on the zebra display and marker display, refer to page 97.

[ZEBRA MODE]
This sets the display duration of the zebra display.
[CONTINUE]:

Displays the zebra display until it is switched to another zebra display setting.

[MOMENT]:

Displays the zebra display for approximately 5 seconds.

[BARS TYPE]
You can switch the type of color bars to be displayed when you press the BARS button. (l 106)
[TYPE 1]

[TYPE 2]

- 173 -

[TYPE 3]

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

174 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[SUB REC BUTTON]
Enable/disable of the sub recording start/stop button on the handle can be switched.
[INHIBIT]/[ACTIVE]

[FAST ZOOM]
When [ON] is selected, you can use Fast Zoom when operating the zoom with the zoom lever.
(l 49)
[ON]/[OFF]

[SUB ZOOM]
Enable/disable of the sub zoom lever on the handle can be switched. Zoom speed will be different
depending on the setting.
[OFF]/[1]/[2]/[3]/[4]/[5]/[6]/[7]
≥ The larger the value is, the faster the zoom speed becomes, and vice versa.
≥ When [FAST ZOOM] is set to [ON] and [7] is selected, the zoom speed becomes as same as Fast
Zoom.

[DIGITAL ZOOM]
Changes the zoom magnification setting of Digital Zoom. (l 87)
[k2]/[k5]/[k10]/[TOGGLE]

[i.Zoom]
You can zoom in while maintaining the beauty of high-definition picture quality up to a magnification
of 30k. (l 49)
≥ Set [REC FORMAT] to a setting with a picture size of 1920k1080 or below. (l 161)
[ON]/[OFF]

[ZOOM/FOCUS]
You can switch between operating controls such as the zoom lever and focus ring with this unit and
operating them with the AG ROP application during AG ROP application connection. (l 150)
[IP REMOTE]/[CAMERA]
≥ Selecting [IP REMOTE] enables you to operate this unit with the AG ROP application, while
selecting [CAMERA] enables you to operate this unit directly.

- 174 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

175 ページ 2016年11月28日

Auto switch setting
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [AUTO SW] # desired setting

[A.IRIS]
This enables/disables Auto Iris for Auto Iris Mode. (l 44)
[ON]/[OFF]

[AGC]
This enables/disables AGC for Auto Iris Mode. (l 44)
[ON]/[OFF]

[AGC LIMIT]
Sets the maximum possible gain value for Auto Gain Mode. (l 70)
[3 dB]/[6 dB]/[9 dB]/[12 dB]/[15 dB]/[18 dB]/[21 dB]/[24 dB]

[AUTO SHUTTER]
This enables/disables Auto Shutter for Auto Mode. (l 44)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 175 -

月曜日

午前11時40分

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

176 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[AUTO SLOW SHTR]
You can record bright pictures even in dark places by slowing the shutter speed.
Slow Shutter works in Auto Shutter Mode. (l 71)
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ The shutter speed will be adjusted to one of the following values according to the ambient
brightness. The value will differ depending on the frame rate of the [REC FORMAT].
Frame rates

Shutter speed

59.94p/59.94i/29.97p

1/30 or more

50.00p/50.00i/25.00p

1/25 or more

23.98p/24.00p

1/24 or more

≥ This item cannot be set during Freeze Frame. (l 89)
≥ When the shutter speed becomes 1/30, 1/25 or 1/24, the screen may be seen as if frames are
missed and after images may appear.

[ATW]
This enables/disables ATW for Auto Mode. (l 44)
[ON]/[OFF]

[AF]
This enables/disables Auto Focus for Auto Mode. (l 44)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 176 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

177 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Recording Setup
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [RECORD SETUP] # desired setting

[MEDIA SELECT]
Card slot can be selected separately to record motion pictures. (l 41)
[SD CARD 1]/[SD CARD 2]

[2 SLOTS FUNC.]
You can set relay/simultaneous/background/dual codec recording.
≥ Insert SD cards to card slot 1 and card slot 2.
[OFF]:

Cancel the setting.

[RELAY REC]*1:

Set the relay recording

[SIMULTANEOUS]*2:

Set the simultaneous recording

[BACKGROUND]*1, 3:

Set the background recording

*1, 2, 4

[DUAL CODEC]

:

Set the dual codec recording

*1

This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
j During the Interval Recording (l 182)
*2 This item is not available when different types of SD cards (SDHC Memory Card/SDXC
Memory Card) are used.
*3 This function is not available in the following cases:
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to a setting with a size of 4K (4096k2160) or UHD (3840k2160)
(l 161)
j When the bit rate of [REC FORMAT] is above 50 Mbps
*4 Set [REC FORMAT] to a setting that allows you to use dual codec recording. (l 181)

- 177 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

178 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Relay recording
This is simple Relay Recording. It is possible to continuously record on the SD card in the other card
slot even when the available capacity of the SD card runs out during the recording.














1
2
3
4




Slot 1
Slot 2
Recording is started
Recording is paused

A
B
C

Recording
The card slot used for recording is switched
automatically.
Replace the SD card with a recordable one.

≥ RELAY is displayed beside the display of the SD card selected as the recording destination of
motion pictures in [MEDIA SELECT] (l 41). When the recording media is switched and Relay
Recording starts, RELAY will disappear from the location and instead be displayed beside the
other SD card display.
≥ Even after switching of the recording media, you can replace the SD card that ran out of space
with a new one and record the motion picture onto three or more SD cards. Since it may take a
while for this unit to recognize a new SD card, replace the SD card that ran out of space when the
SD card currently being used as a destination still has sufficient remaining recordable time.
≥ The maximum recording time for Relay Recording is 10 hours.
≥ When the recording time of Relay Recording reaches 10 hours, the recording will stop
temporarily. It will restart automatically a few seconds later.

∫ Simultaneous recording
Same motion picture can be recorded on two SD cards.



1
2
3
4











Slot 1
Slot 2
Recording is started
Recording is paused

A

Recording

≥ SIMUL is displayed beside the display of the SD card selected as the recording destination of
motion pictures in [MEDIA SELECT] (l 41).
≥ If you set the recording destination of motion pictures to [SD CARD 1] in [MEDIA SELECT], they
will also be recorded to [SD CARD 2] simultaneously.
≥ We recommend that you perform simultaneous recording using SD cards of the same Speed
Class rating and capacity.

- 178 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

179 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Background recording
You can continue recording a motion picture by recording it on the SD card that is not set as a
recording destination in [MEDIA SELECT] (l 41).























5
6







1
2
3
4



Slot 1
Slot 2
Press the recording start/stop button.
Press and hold the USER button to which
[BACKGROUND] is registered.
Recording is started
Recording is paused

A

Recording

≥ When the recording destination of motion pictures is set to [SD CARD 1] in [MEDIA SELECT],
[SD CARD 2] will be used for background recording. The following instructions assume that the
recording destination of motion pictures is set to [SD CARD 1].
≥ BACKGR is displayed beside the SD card display for card 2.

How to use background recording
≥ Register [BACKGROUND] to a USER button. (l 82)

1

Press the recording start/stop button to start recording.

≥ A motion picture will start being recorded to the two SD cards. ( BACKGR will be displayed in red.)
≥ If you press the USER button to which [BACKGROUND] is registered, you can start recording
only to the SD card in card slot 2.
≥ For information on how to register a function to USER buttons, refer to page 82. For information
on how to use the USER button to which [BACKGROUND] is registered, refer to page 93.

2

Press the recording start/stop button again to stop recording.

≥ Recording to the SD card in card slot 1 will stop, but recording to the SD card in card slot 2 will
continue.
≥ You can repeat recording to the SD card in card slot 1 by pressing the recording start/stop button.
≥ You can stop background recording by pressing and holding the USER button to which
[BACKGROUND] is registered.

- 179 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

180 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

∫ Dual codec recording
You can make main and sub recordings in separate [REC FORMAT] settings.
Sub recording records scenes in a picture quality lower than that of the [REC FORMAT] setting for
main recording.



1
2
3
4











Slot 1
Slot 2
Recording is started
Recording is paused

A
B

Recording
Recording in low picture quality

≥ If you set the recording destination of motion picture to [SD CARD 1] in [MEDIA SELECT] (l 41),
[SD CARD 1] will be used for main recording, while [SD CARD 2] will be used for sub recording.
≥ Set the sub recording scene setting in [DUAL CODEC REC].
≥ The icon for the card used for main recording will be displayed with DUAL 50M or DUAL 8M .
(Relay recording)
≥ After performing the relay recording, a message about the remaining card capacity will be
displayed. Replace the SD card that ran out of space or set [2 SLOTS FUNC.] to [OFF].
(Simultaneous recording)
≥ When performing simultaneous recording, even in the case where an error has occurred in one of
the SD cards and recording has stopped, recording can be continued using the other SD card.
≥ When one of the media reaches its maximum recording time, the simultaneous recording stops.
(Background recording)
≥ An alert sound is not emitted for background recording.
≥ Background recording stops in the following cases:
j When you have turned off this unit
j When the SD card being used as a background recording destination runs out of space
≥ If the SD card being used as a background recording destination runs out of space during motion
picture recording, background recording does not restart automatically even if you replace the SD
card.
(Dual codec recording)
≥ Main recording does not stop even if an error occurs in the memory card used for sub recording.
If an error occurs in the memory card used for main recording, the recording stops.
≥ When the main recording scene is automatically divided during recording, the sub recording
scene will also be divided at the same time. (l 43)

- 180 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

181 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[DUAL CODEC REC]
This sets the sub recording scene settings for dual codec recording.
≥ For information on dual codec recording, refer to page 180.
≥ Select a [REC FORMAT] setting that supports dual codec recording. (See below.)
[FHD 50Mbps]:

Performs recording at a bit rate of 50Mbps. Scenes can be saved in either
MOV or MP4 format.

[FHD 8Mbps]:

Performs recording at a bit rate of 8Mbps. Scenes can be saved in MOV
format.

≥ Sub recording scenes will be recorded with the following settings:
j Recording is performed with a size setting of FHD (1920k1080)
j When [FHD 50Mbps] is selected, the [REC MODE] setting selected for sub recording will be
the same as the setting selected for main recording (MOV/MP4).
j Recording is performed at the same frame rate as that of the [REC FORMAT] setting for main
recording.

∫ [REC FORMAT] settings that support main recording of dual codec recording
(When [DUAL CODEC REC] is set to [FHD 50Mbps])
Recording mode
MOV, MP4

System frequency setting

Recording format

[59.94Hz]

UHD 2160/29.97p 100M,
UHD 2160/23.98p 100M

[50.00Hz]

UHD 2160/25.00p 100M

(When [DUAL CODEC REC] is set to [FHD 8Mbps])
Recording mode

System frequency setting

Recording format

[59.94Hz]

UHD 2160/29.97p 100M,
UHD 2160/23.98p 100M,
FHD 1080/59.94p
,
FHD 1080/59.94p 100M,
FHD 1080/29.97p
,
FHD 1080/23.98p

[50.00Hz]

UHD 2160/25.00p 100M,
FHD 1080/50.00p
,
FHD 1080/50.00p 100M,
FHD 1080/25.00p

MOV, MP4

≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to a setting that does not support dual codec recording.

- 181 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

182 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[INTERVAL REC]
A scene that moves slowly for long period of time is recorded frame by frame with an interval, and is
recorded as a short time motion picture.
One frame is recorded every recording interval that is set.
≥ The number of frames per second differs depending on the frame rate of [REC FORMAT].
j 59.94i or 29.97p: 30 frames make up a scene of 1 second
j 50.00i or 25.00p: 25 frames make up a scene of 1 second
j 24.00p: 24 frames make up a scene of 1 second
≥ To set [REC FORMAT] (l 161)
≥ Following recording formats enable Interval Recording.
System Frequency
setting

Recording format

[59.94Hz]

[4K 2160/24.00p 100M], [UHD 2160/29.97p 100M],
[FHD 1080/29.97p 50M], [HA 1080/59.94i]

[50.00Hz]

[4K 2160/24.00p 100M], [UHD 2160/25.00p 100M],
[FHD 1080/25.00p 50M], [HA 1080/50.00i]

[OFF]/[1 SEC.]/[10 SEC.]/[30 SEC.]/[1 MINUTE]/[2 MINUTES]
≥ [I-] is displayed on the screen. The icon changes to [I-REC] after recording starts.
≥ After recording, the setting of Interval Recording is canceled.
≥ Audio cannot be recorded.

(Setup examples based on a [SYSTEM FREQ] setting of [59.94Hz])
Setup example

Setup time
(recording interval)

Recording time

Recorded time

Sunset

1s

1h

2 min

Blooming

30 s

3h

12 s

≥ “h” is an abbreviation for hour, “min” for minute and “s” for second.
≥ These times are approximations.
≥ Maximum recordable time is 168 hours.
≥ This function is not available in the following cases:
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j PRE-REC is used (l 95, 183)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ [INTERVAL REC] is canceled in the following cases.
j If you turn the unit off
j If you press the THUMBNAIL button
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)
j If you set [REC FORMAT] unsupported for [INTERVAL REC].
≥ The shortest motion picture recording time is approx. 2 second.
≥ Color balance and focus may not be adjusted automatically depending on light sources or
scenes. If so, manually adjust these settings. (l 52, 63)
≥ We recommend connecting the AC adaptor to this unit when recording images for a long period of time.

- 182 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

183 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[VFR MODE]
This enables/disables Variable Frame Rate Mode.
In Variable Frame Rate Mode, you can record quick or slow motion picture by changing the frame
rate before recording.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ For information on how to use Variable Frame Rate Mode, refer to page 100.

[FRAME RATE]
You can adjust the frame rate for Variable Frame Rate Mode.
≥ Set [VFR MODE] to [ON]. (l 100, 183)

1
2

Touch [FRAME RATE].
Touch
/
to adjust the frame rate.

≥ You can select a value between 2 fps and 60 fps or 2 fps and 50 fps.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ The default setting varies depending on the [REC FORMAT] setting.
j [FHD 1080/29.97p 50M]: “30fps”.
j [FHD 1080/23.98p 50M]: “24fps”.
j [FHD 1080/25.00p 50M]: “25fps”.
≥ When [REC MODE] and [REC FORMAT] are set to settings that are not available for Variable
Frame Rate Mode, [FRAME RATE] cannot be set. (l 100)

[SUPER SLOW REC]
This enables/disables Super Slow Recording. (l 103)
[ON]/[OFF]

[PRE-REC]
This allows the recording of an image and audio to start before you press the recording start/stop
button. AVCHD scenes will be recorded from approximately 3 seconds before the operation, while
MOV/MP4 will be recorded from approximately 4 seconds before the operation. (l 95)
[ON]/[OFF]

[INFRARED REC]
Selecting [ON] enables Infrared Recording Mode, allowing you to record images in the dark. (l 92)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 183 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

184 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[IR REC COLOR]
This changes the color in which images are recorded in Infrared Recording Mode.
[Green]/[White]

[FOCUS TRANSITION]
You can register a focus position to Focus Transition. (l 60)
≥ Switch to Manual Focus. (l 52)
[SET]/[OFF]

[FOCUS TRANSITION TIME]
You can set the length of time in which the focus will shift during Focus Transition. (l 62)
[DIRECT]/[FASTEST]/[2-15 SEC.]/[20 SEC.]/[30 SEC.]/[45 SEC.]/[60 SEC.]/[90 SEC.]
≥ This function’s default setting is 2 seconds.

[FOCUS TRANSITION REC]
You can start recording and Focus Transition simultaneously. (l 62)
[1]/[2]/[3]/[OFF]

[FOCUS TRANSITION WAIT]
You can set the length of time before Focus Transition starts. (l 62)
[0 SEC.]/[5 SEC.]/[10 SEC.]

[TIME STAMP]
You can stamp the date and time of recording on the images you record.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥

appears on the screen.

≥ The display mode and format of the date and time of recording to be stamped vary depending on
the settings for [DATE/TIME] and [DATE FORMAT]. (l 193)
≥ The month of the date and time of recording is recorded in English.

- 184 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

185 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ In the following cases, even when [TIME STAMP] is set to [ON], the date and time of recording
are not displayed:
j When [REC FORMAT] is set to [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i] (l 161)
j When [2 SLOTS FUNC.] is set to [DUAL CODEC] (l 177)
j When [DATE/TIME] is set to [OFF]
j During Freeze Frame (l 89)
j During Super Slow Recording (l 103)
j In Variable Frame Rate Mode (l 100)
≥ Even when [VIDEO OUT OSD] is set to [OFF], the date and time of recording are displayed on
the external monitor screen. (l 127)
≥ The date and time of recording displayed during [TIME STAMP] recording and the date and time
displayed during the playback of the image may not exactly be the same.

[DF MODE]
Selects the compensation mode for the time code. (l 79)
≥ Set [SYSTEM FREQ] to [59.94Hz]. (l 160)
[DF]/[NDF]

[TCG]
Sets the way the time code will move. (l 79)
[FREE RUN]/[REC RUN]

[TC PRESET]
Initial value of the time code can be set. (l 80)

[UB PRESET]
≥ Set [REC MODE] to [AVCHD]. (l 160)
User Information can be set. (l 80)

- 185 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

186 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Audio Setup
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [AUDIO SETUP] # desired setting

[AUDIO LOW CUT CH1]
Reduces the level of low-pitched sound for audio channel 1.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ You may not see the full effect depending on the recording conditions.

[AUDIO LOW CUT CH2]
Reduces the level of low-pitched sound for audio channel 2.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ You may not see the full effect depending on the recording conditions.

[AUDIO LEVEL CH1]
Switches the adjustment method of the audio recording level for audio channel 1. (l 76)
[AUTO]/[MANUAL]

[AUDIO LEVEL CH2]
Switches the adjustment method of the audio recording level for audio channel 2. (l 76)
[AUTO]/[MANUAL]

[AUDIO ALC LINK]
If you set this item to [ON], when ALC works for either of the audio channels, it will also work for the
other audio channel. (l 77)
≥ Set [AUDIO LEVEL CH1]/[AUDIO LEVEL CH2] to [MANUAL].
≥ Set [AUDIO ALC CH1]/[AUDIO ALC CH2] to [ON]. (l 77)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 186 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

187 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[AUDIO ALC CH1]
If you set this item to [ON], you can reduce the audio noise of audio channel 1.
It will record with natural sound when set to [OFF]. (l 77)
≥ Set [AUDIO LEVEL CH1] to [MANUAL]. (l 76)
[ON]/[OFF]

[AUDIO ALC CH2]
If you set this item to [ON], you can reduce the audio noise of audio channel 2.
It will record with natural sound when set to [OFF]. (l 77)
≥ Set [AUDIO LEVEL CH2] to [MANUAL]. (l 76)
[ON]/[OFF]

[INPUT1 LINE LEVEL]
Sets the input level of the audio equipment connected to AUDIO INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin).
[+4dBu]/[0dBu]

[INPUT2 LINE LEVEL]
Sets the input level of the audio equipment connected to AUDIO INPUT2 terminal (XLR 3 pin).
[+4dBu]/[0dBu]

[INPUT1 MIC LEVEL]
Sets the input level of the external microphone connected to AUDIO INPUT1 terminal (XLR 3 pin).
[-40 dB]/[-50 dB]/[-60 dB]

[INPUT2 MIC LEVEL]
Sets the input level of the external microphone connected to AUDIO INPUT2 terminal (XLR 3 pin).
[-40 dB]/[-50 dB]/[-60 dB]

- 187 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

188 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Output Setup
Different menu items are displayed depending on whether this unit is in Recording Mode or
Playback Mode.
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [OUTPUT SETUP] # desired setting

[RESOLUTION]
This changes the way in which images are output to an external device. (l 128)
[SYSTEM]/[1080p]/[1080i]/[DOWN CONV.]

[REMOTE REC]
This enables/disables a function that controls recording performed with an external device
connected to the unit.
[ON]/[OFF]

[REMOTE REC LINK]
When [ON] is selected, you can control recording performed with this unit and an external device
using the recording start/stop button.
[ON]:

Controls recording performed with this unit and an external device using the
recording start/stop button.

[OFF]:

Controls recording performed with an external device using the USER button
function [AUTO REC]. (l 98)

- 188 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

189 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[DOWN CONV.]
This function allows you to select how to display images with a 16:9 aspect ratio on an external
monitor with a 4:3 aspect ratio. (l 127)
≥ Set [RESOLUTION] to [DOWN CONV.]. (l 128)
[SIDE CROP]/[LETTERBOX]/[SQUEEZE]

[HDMI UHD OUTPUT LIMIT]
This sets a frame rate when outputting scenes in the recording format [UHD 2160/59.94p 150M] or
[UHD 2160/50.00p 150M] from the HDMI OUT terminal.
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [59.94Hz])
[59.94p]:

Outputs scenes in 2160/59.94p.

[29.97p]:

Outputs scenes in 2160/29.97p.

(When [SYSTEM FREQ] is set to [50.00Hz])
[50.00p]:

Outputs scenes in 2160/50.00p.

[25.00p]:

Outputs scenes in 2160/25.00p.

[HDMI TC OUTPUT]
Switches the output setting of time code information when this unit is connected to another device
(HDMI-SDI converter, etc.) with an HDMI cable.
≥ To remotely record scenes to the external device connected to the HDMI OUT terminal using the
USER button function [AUTO REC], select [ON]. (l 98)
≥ (In Playback Mode)
Touch the play mode select icon, and set this unit to Motion Picture Playback Mode.
(l 113)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 189 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

190 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[AV OUT]
Enable/disable output from the VIDEO OUT terminal or AUDIO OUT terminal. (l 128)
[ON]/[OFF]

[H/PHONE MODE]
Change the type of sound to be output from the headphone and AUDIO OUT terminals.
[LIVE]:

The sound which has been input from the microphone is output as is.
This setting is selected when delays in the sound are annoying.

[RECORDING]:

The sound in the status which is to be recorded (the sound
synchronized with the images) is output.

≥ When an HDMI cable is connected to this unit, even if you select [LIVE], sound will be output
according to [RECORDING].

[VOLUME]
When [ON] is selected, you can adjust the headphone volume in Recording Mode with the jog dial.
(l 112)
[ON]/[OFF]

[TEST TONE]
Selects the test tone output when color bars are displayed. (l 106)
[OFF]:

Does not output a test tone.

[LEVEL 1]:

Outputs a high volume test tone.

[LEVEL 2]:

Outputs a low volume test tone.

[LCD/EVF OUTPUT]
This sets how to turn on/off the LCD monitor and viewfinder. (l 32)
[AUTO]/[LCD]

- 190 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

191 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Display setting
Different menu items are displayed depending on whether this unit is in Recording Mode or
Playback Mode.
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [DISP SETUP] # desired setting

[ZEBRA DETECT 1]
Selects the brightness level of the left-leaning zebra patterns on the screen.

1

Touch [ZEBRA DETECT 1].

≥ Touch [YES].

2

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 50% and 105%.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ This function’s default setting is “80%”.

[ZEBRA DETECT 2]
Selects the brightness level of the right-leaning zebra patterns on the screen.
[SET]/[OFF]

1

Touch [ZEBRA DETECT 2].

≥ Touch [SET].

2

Touch

/

to adjust settings.

≥ You can select a value between 50% and 105%.

3

Touch [EXIT] to complete the setting.

≥ You can display [ZEBRA 2] after setting the level. (l 97, 173)
≥ This function’s default setting is “100%”.

[MARKER]
Displaying of the luminance level display marker can be switched.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ Marker can be displayed when set to [ON]. (l 97, 173)

- 191 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

192 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[GUIDE LINES]
You can check if the image is level while recording motion pictures and still pictures. The function
can also be used to estimate the balance of the composition.
/

/

/[OFF]

≥ The guidelines do not appear on the images actually recorded.
≥ The setting changes as follows when using Focus Assist. (l 56)
j The guidelines are not displayed. (They are displayed on the external monitor when this unit is
connected to the external monitor.)
j The setting cannot be changed.

[SAFETY ZONE]
Display of the range that can be displayed with the external monitor (safety zone A) can be
switched.
(When [16:9 90%] is set)
Aspect ratio

[SAFETY ZONE]

16:9

[16:9 90%]/[4:3]/[14:9]/[1.85:1]/[17:9]/
[2:1]/[2.35:1]/[2.39:1]/[OFF]

4:3*

[4:3 90%]/[4:3]/[OFF]


* When [REC FORMAT] is set to [SA 480/59.94i] or [SA 576/50.00i] and [ASPECT CONVERT] is
set to [SIDE CROP] (l 161, 165)
≥ The safety zone is not displayed on the images that is actually recorded.

[CENTER MARKER]
Displays/hides the center marker.
[ON]/[OFF]

[REC COUNTER]
Selects the operation of the Recording Counter during recording. (l 81)
[TOTAL]/[SCENE]

- 192 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

193 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[FOCUS DISPLAY]
This changes the units of focus values.
[NUMBER]
[feet]
[m]
[OFF]

A value between 0 and 99 is displayed.
All values are displayed in feet.
All values are displayed in meter.
No value is displayed.

[ZOOM DISPLAY]
This changes the units of zoom values.
[NUMBER]

A value between 0 and 99 is displayed.

[mm]

All values are displayed in millimeter.

[OFF]

No value is displayed.

[VIDEO OUT OSD]
The information displayed on the screen (operation icon and counter display etc.) can be displayed/
not displayed on the external monitor. (l 127)
[ON]/[OFF]

[DATE/TIME]
It is possible to change the date and time display mode.
[OFF]/[TIME]/[DATE]/[DATE&TIME]

[DATE FORMAT]
It is possible to change the date format.
[Y/M/D]/[M/D/Y]/[D/M/Y]

[LEVEL GAUGE]
This function displays the horizontal/vertical tilt of the unit with the electronic level. (l 93)
[ON]/[OFF]

- 193 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

194 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[AUDIO LEVEL METER]
Select to display the audio level meter.
≥ (In Playback Mode)
Touch the play mode select icon, and set this unit to Motion Picture Playback Mode.
(l 113)
[ON]/[OFF]

[LENS STATUS]
Display relating to lens can be switched. (Zoom Display, Optical Image Stabilizer, ND filter, Focus
Display, White Balance, Iris, Gain, Auto Iris, Shutter Speed)
[ON]/[OFF]

[CARD & BATTERY]
Display can be switched between the remaining recordable time of the SD card and the remaining
battery capacity indication.
[ON]/[OFF]

[OTHER DISPLAY]
This shows or hides indications on the screen except for [USER BUTTON DISPLAY], [GUIDE
LINES], [SAFETY ZONE], [CENTER MARKER], [DATE/TIME], [AUDIO LEVEL METER],
[LENS STATUS] and [CARD & BATTERY].
[ON]/[OFF]

[POWER LCD]
This makes it easier to view the LCD monitor in bright places including outdoors. (l 35)
[+1]/[0]/[-1]
≥ When the AC adaptor is in use, [+1] is automatically selected.

[LCD SET]
It adjusts brightness and color density on the LCD monitor. (l 35)
[COLOUR]/[BRIGHTNESS]/[CONTRAST]
≥ The default settings are as follows:
j [COLOUR]: “0”
j [BRIGHTNESS]: “0”
j [CONTRAST]: “0”

- 194 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

195 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[EVF SETTING]
Adjusts the brightness and color intensity of the viewfinder. (l 36)
[COLOUR]/[BRIGHTNESS]/[CONTRAST]
≥ The default settings are as follows:
j [COLOUR]: “0”
j [BRIGHTNESS]: “0”
j [CONTRAST]: “0”

[EYE SENSOR]
Adjusts the eye sensor sensitivity. (l 37)
≥ This function’s default setting is “s2”.

[SELF SHOOT]
Switches the mirror function of the LCD monitor when recording yourself. (l 37)
The image on the LCD monitor is displayed mirrored horizontally during recording of yourself when
it is set to [MIRROR].
[MIRROR]/[NORMAL]

[EVF COLOUR]
The recording images or playback images on the viewfinder can be selected between color/black
and white. (l 37)
[ON]/[OFF]

[EVF/LCD DETAIL]
Setting this item to [ON] helps you achieve focus easier by emphasizing the outlines of an image
displayed on the LCD monitor and viewfinder. (l 53)
[ON]/[OFF]

[EVF/LCD PEAK LEVEL]
Adjusts the emphasis strength for [EVF/LCD DETAIL]. (l 53)
≥ This function’s default setting is “0”.

[EVF/LCD PEAK FREQ.]
Sets the peaking frequency for [EVF/LCD DETAIL]. (l 53)
[HIGH]/[LOW]

- 195 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

196 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Other Functions
Different menu items are displayed depending on whether this unit is in Recording Mode or
Playback Mode.
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [OTHER FUNCTION] # desired setting

[FORMAT MEDIA]
The SD card or the external media device can be formatted. (l 42, 138)
≥ Please be aware that if a medium is formatted, then all the data recorded on the medium will be
erased and cannot be restored. Back up important data on a PC etc. (l 133)

[MEDIA STATUS]
The used space and remaining recordable time of the SD card can be checked.
≥ Touching [CHANGE MEDIA] switches the unit between the display for the SD card 1 and the
display for the SD card 2.
≥ Only in Recording Mode, remaining recordable time for the selected recording format is
displayed.
≥ Touch [EXIT] to close the indication.
≥ The SD card requires some space to store information and manage system files, so the actual
usable space is slightly less than the indicated value. The usable space is generally calculated as
1 GB=1,000,000,000 bytes. The capacities of this unit, PCs and software are expressed as
1 GB=1,024k1,024k1,024=1,073,741,824 bytes. Therefore, the indicated value of the capacity
appears to be smaller.

[PICTURE MEDIA SELECT]
You can specify the card slot to which still pictures are to be recorded.
≥ You can save the desired frame of a recorded motion picture as a still picture. (l 118)
[SD CARD 1]/[SD CARD 2]

[REC LAMP]
The recording lamp lights up during recording. When this is set to [OFF], it does not light during
recording.
[FRONT]/[REAR]/[BOTH]/[OFF]

[CLOCK SET]
Set date and time. (l 38)

[TIME ZONE]
Set the time difference from Greenwich Mean Time. (l 38)

- 196 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

197 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[ALERT SOUND]
Touch screen operation, start and stop of recording can be confirmed with this sound.
When [OFF] is selected, the sound is not output at the start/end of recording, etc.
[OFF]/

(Volume low)/

(Volume high)

2 Beeps for 4 times
When an error occurs. Check the message displayed on the screen. (l 206)

[ECONOMY (BATT)]
When about 5 minutes have passed without any operation, this unit automatically turns off to save
battery life.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ This unit will not automatically turn off even if the [ECONOMY (BATT)] is set to [ON] in following
cases:
j PRE-REC is used (l 95, 183)
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)

[ECONOMY (AC)]
When connected to AC adaptor about 15 minutes have passed without any operation, this unit
automatically turns off.
[ON]/[OFF]
≥ This unit will not automatically turn off even if the [ECONOMY (AC)] is set to [ON] in following
cases:
j PRE-REC is used (l 95, 183)
j When [USB MODE SELECT] is set to [DEVICE] and this unit is connected to a PC. (l 133)

[SYSTEM FREQ]
Set the system frequency of this unit. (l 160)

[USB MODE]
Enable/disable connections to the USB terminals of this unit. (l 102)
[ON]/[OFF]

[USB MODE SELECT]
The unit’s USB terminal to which a USB Cable will be connected can be switched.
Switch the terminal according to the shape of the USB Cable’s plug you intend to connect to the
unit.
[HOST]:

For connecting to the USB HOST terminal (Type A) of the unit

[DEVICE]:

For connecting to the USB DEVICE terminal (Type Micro-B) of the unit

- 197 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

198 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[INITIAL SET]
The menu settings or [FILE SELECT] are reset to the default. (l 151)
[ALL]:

This is for initializing all menus.*

[SCENE]:

This is for initializing the setting of each scene number of [FILE
SELECT].

[NETWORK]:

This is for initializing the [NETWORK SETUP] menu settings.

[NO]:

This is for not performing initialization.

* Settings for [CLOCK SET], [TIME ZONE] and [SYSTEM FREQ] will not be changed.
≥ Returning all settings to the default is not possible during Freeze Frame. (l 89)

[NUMBER RESET]
Set the file number of the next MOV/MP4 and still picture to be saved to 0001.
≥ Folder number is updated and file number will start from 0001. (l 134)
≥ To reset the folder number, format the SD card, and then perform [NUMBER RESET].

[SOFTWARE INFO]
You can view the software information (License) on a PC connected to this unit with a USB 3.0
cable.
≥ Set [USB MODE SELECT] to [DEVICE]. (l 197)
≥ Set [USB MODE] to [ON]. (l 197)

1
2

Touch [SOFTWARE INFO].
Connect this unit to a PC. (l 133)

≥ A message will be displayed when the connection is complete. On the PC, confirm
[LICENSE.TXT].
≥ When using the battery, the LCD monitor turns off after about 5 seconds. Touch the screen to turn
the LCD monitor on.

[LANGUAGE]
You can select the language on the screen display and the menu screen.
HC-X1E
[English]/[Deutsch]/[Français]/[Italiano]/[Nederlands]/[Svenska]/[Español]/
[Polski]/[Česky]/[Magyar]/[Türkçe]
HC-X1GC
[English]

- 198 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

199 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Network Setup
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
MENU

: [NETWORK SETUP] # desired setting

[USER ACCOUNT]
Set up a login user account for the AG ROP application. (l 143)
[SET]/[OFF]

[WIRELESS SETUP]
Set the wireless LAN connection method. (l 146)
[DIRECT]/[SSID(SELECT)]/[SSID(MANUAL)]

[Wireless LAN setup]
You can change or check the network setup, such as the IP address, subnet mask, and MAC
address for wireless LAN connections. (l 145)
[IP Address]/[Subnet Mask]/[Gateway]/[DHCP]/[MAC Address]

[CONNECTION HISTORY]
A history of connections made to wireless access points are displayed. You can easily connect with
the same settings as used previously by selecting a connection record from History. (l 149)

[NETWORK INITIAL SETTING]
You can change the [NETWORK SETUP] menu back to the default condition.

- 199 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

200 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

[NETWORK SETUP PASSWORD]
This will set/clear the Password to limit the startup of the [NETWORK SETUP] menu.
By setting the Password, it will prevent erroneous operation, prevent wrongful use of the wireless
LAN function by third party, and protect the set personal information.
[Setup]/[Delete]

1
2

Touch [Setup].
Enter a password (six characters).

≥ After finish entering the Password, touch [Enter].
≥ For details on how to enter characters, refer to page 144.

3

Re-enter the password.

≥ After finish entering the Password, touch [Enter].
≥ If the Passwords match with each other, a message is displayed.
≥ After setting a password, you will be required to enter it each time you touch the [NETWORK
SETUP] menu.
≥ If you have forgotten the password, from the menu, select [OTHER FUNCTION] # [INITIAL SET]
# [NETWORK]. This will reset the [NETWORK SETUP] menu to the default settings, allowing
you to use it again.

Maintenance
MENU

: [MAINTENANCE] # desired setting

[VERSION]
The version of the firmware of this unit is displayed.

[UPDATE]
The firmware of this unit is updated.
For the latest update information, check the support website below.
(As of November 2016)
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/e_cam
(This Site is English only)

[HOUR METER]
This displays the operation time of this unit, how many times the zoom lever has been operated,
how many times the zoom motor has worked and how many times the jog dial has been pressed.

- 200 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

201 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Video Setup
All default settings are indicated with underlined text.
≥ Press the THUMBNAIL button to switch this unit to the Playback Mode.
≥ Touch the play mode select icon, and set this unit to Motion Picture Playback Mode.
(l 113)
MENU

: [VIDEO SETUP] # desired setting

[REPEAT PLAY]
Playback of the first scene starts after playback of the last scene finishes when set to [ON]. (l 119)
[ON]/[OFF]

[RESUME PLAY]
If playback of a scene was stopped halfway, the playback can be resumed from where it was
stopped when set to [ON]. (l 119)
[ON]/[OFF]

[SCENE PROTECT]
Scenes can be protected so that they are not deleted by mistake.
(Even if you protect some scenes, formatting the SD card will delete them.) (l 122)

[DELETE]
Deletes a scene. (l 121)

- 201 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

202 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Picture Setup
≥ Press the THUMBNAIL button to switch this unit to the Playback Mode.
≥ Touch the play mode select icon, and set this unit to Still Picture Playback Mode. (l 113)
MENU

: [PHOTO SETUP] # desired setting

[SCENE PROTECT]
Still pictures can be protected so that they are not deleted by mistake.
(Even if you protect some still pictures, formatting the SD card will delete them.) (l 122)

[DELETE]
Deletes a still picture. (l 121)

Copy
≥ Press the THUMBNAIL button to switch this unit to the Playback Mode.
MENU

: [COPY] # desired setting

[DIFFERENTIAL COPY]
This copies all scenes and still pictures recorded with this unit that have never been copied to
another device to the external media device connected to this unit. (l 139)

[SELECT COPY]
This allows you to select and copy the scenes/still pictures. You can copy between the SD cards in
this unit or from either of them to the external media device. (l 123, 139)
[

]/[

]/[

]/[

]

- 202 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

203 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Display

Indications
∫ Recording indications
Example: Display in English





I- REC HDMI

TC 00:00:00:00
R 1h20m
R 1h20m

EX.SENS.

DRS
FLUO
D 5X
5600K Ach
ND1/64
0dB
A.SHTR 1/100

150M
25:25.00p FBC
VFR
99%
SHUTTER
OPEN

MNL

DUAL 50M ,
DUAL 8M

A
TC 00:00:00.00/TC 00:00:00:00
Counter display (l 78)
I-

Interval Recording (l 182)

I-REC (Red)

Interval Recording (Recording)

P-

PRE-REC (l 95, 183)

EXTENDED SENSITIVITY
(l 165)

H.SENS

High sensitivity recording mode
(l 166)

DRS

DRS (l 89, 158)
Area Mode (l 90)

Recording

REC
Recording pause
(Flashing red)

,

Dual codec recording (l 180,
181)

EX.SENS.

P-REC (Red) PRE-REC (Recording)
REC (Red)

AF50
Z00

15 11 2016 15:30:00
AUTO

AF-AREA

AF Area Width adjustment
(l 55)

Freeze

Freeze Frame (l 89)

Automatic recording (l 98)

,

Auto Mode (l 44)
Remaining battery power (l 27)

Wireless LAN connection
status (l 146)

,
(White)

Recording to card possible
(motion picture)

AG ROP application
connection status (l 146)

,
(Green)

Card is being recognized
(motion picture)

R 1h20m

Remaining time for motion
picture recording (l 43)

MAIN

/

Image Stabilizer (l 50)

Infrared recording (l 92, 183)
FLUO

The title of the scene number
(l 151)
B

Card slot selected for motion
picture recording (during
normal recording) (l 41, 43)

,
,

,
,

,
,

RELAY

Relay recording (l 178)

Recording format (l 161)

SIMUL

Simultaneous recording (l 178)

BACKGR

Background recording (l 179)

ALL-I, 150M, 100M, 50M
Bit rate (l 161)
D 2X, D 5X,
D 10X

- 203 -

Digital Zoom (l 87)

,

,

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

204 ページ 2016年11月28日

,
Recording mode (l 160)

When [AUDIO ALC CH1],
[AUDIO ALC CH2], [AUDIO
ALC LINK] are enabled (l 77)

25:25.00p
Frame rate in Variable Frame Rate Mode
(l 100, 183)

ALC

59.94p, 59.94i, 50.00p, 50.00i, 29.97p,
25.00p, 24.00p, 23.98p
Frame rate (l 161)

When [AUDIO ALC CH1],
[AUDIO ALC CH2], [AUDIO
ALC LINK] are enabled and
audio cannot be recorded.
(l 100, 103)

FBC

Flash band compensation
(l 94, 166)

15 NOV 2016 15:30:00
Time Stamp (l 184)

5600K

Color temperature display
(l 63)

15 11 2016 15:30:00
Date indication
Time indication (l 38)

ATW, LOCK, P3200K, P5600K, VAR, Ach,
Bch
White Balance (l 63)

S
E
Focus Transition bar (l 61)
Focus Macro (l 102, 172)

SUPER SLOW
Super Slow Recording (l 103, 183)
Variable Frame Rate mode
(l 100, 183)

ND 1/4,
ND 1/16,
ND 1/64

ND filter (l 107)

99%

Luminance level (l 90, 97)

AF50, MF50, MA50,
Focus (l 52)
AUTO ,
MNL

A.REC

00

[AUDIO LEVEL CH1],
[AUDIO LEVEL CH2] (l 76)

Sound recording disabled
(l 100, 103)
Backlight Compensation
(l 85)

AGC, 0 dB
Gain value (l 69)

Spotlight (l 86)

SHUTTER Multi Manual Function (l 111)

1/100.0

00,

Auto iris mode (l 67)

Center Marker (l 192)

1/100

00,

Audio level meter (l 76)

Luminance display frame
(l 97)

A.SHTR

午前11時40分

When [AUDIO ALC CH1],
[AUDIO ALC CH2] are enabled
(l 77)

100:25.00p
Frame rate during Super Slow Recording
(l 103, 183)

VFR

月曜日

Auto Shutter display (l 71)
Shutter speed (l 71)

OPEN, F2.0

Iris value (l 67)

Z00, iZ00

Zoom magnification (l 48, 49)

Z99

Synchro Scan (l 73)

99
C
Time Stamp recording in
progress (l 184)
When [AUDIO ALC CH1] is
enabled (l 77)
When [AUDIO ALC CH2] is
enabled (l 77)

- 204 -

i.Zoom (l 49)
Fast Zoom (l 49)

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

205 ページ 2016年11月28日

∫ Playback indications

10

No.0010

150M

4K

50.00p

HE

午前11時40分

Scene Number (In 9-scene
display in thumbnail mode)
(l 113)

Example: Display in English

TC 00:00:00:00

月曜日

,
,

UHD
PM

,
,

FHD

,

DU50

,

DU8

,

PH

,

PS

,

HA

,

SA

Recording format (When thumbnails are
displayed) (l 113, 161)
ICONS

Resume Playback (in
thumbnail view) (l 119)

15:30
15 11 2016

1, ;, 5,
, 6,
D, E, ;1, 2;

Protected motion pictures/still
pictures (in thumbnail view)
(l 122)

, 7, 8, 9, :,

∫ Indication of connection to the
external media device

Display during playback (l 113, 117)
TC 00:00:00.00/TC 00:00:00:00

Playback of the external media
device (l 140)

Counter Display (l 78)
,
(White)

Card slot number

No.0010

Scene Number

100-0001

Still picture folder/file name

∫ Indication of connection to
other devices
Accessing the card (l 134)

Repeat Playback (l 119)
15:30

Time indication (l 38)

15 11 2016

Date indication (l 38)

,
(White)

Card slot selected as the
recording destination of still
pictures (l 196)

∫ Confirmatory indications
–– (Time
display)

Warning for recording of yourself
(l 37)

8.8M , 8.3M , 2.1 M , 0.9M
Number of recording pixels for still pictures
(l 118)

SD card is not inserted.
SD card is write-protected.

In Playback Mode, the picture size is not
displayed for still pictures recorded with other
products that have different picture sizes from
the sizes shown above.
R3000
(Red)

The built-in battery is low. (l 38)

Remaining number of still
pictures (l 118)
Recording still picture (l 118)

,
,
Recording mode (When thumbnails are
displayed) (l 113)

- 205 -

SD card is non-compatible.
SD card is full.
Playback-only SD card

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

206 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Display

Messages
Major confirmation/error messages to be indicated on the screen in text.

During recording/playback
Display

Description

Behavior and cause

CHECK CARD.

The SD card is not supported by this
unit.

≥ Check the SD card.

THIS CARD CANNOT
RECORD IN VIDEO
MODE.

This is displayed when the SD card
has a capacity of less than 4 GB.

≥ Use an SD card with a
capacity of 4 GB or more.

INCOMPATIBLE CARD.
CHECK CARD SPEED.

This is displayed if the maximum
writing speed of the SD card is not
fast enough.

≥ The operation will
continue.
≥ Use an SD card with a
maximum writing speed
that is fast enough.

CANNOT EDIT.

The SD card cannot be used with
this unit.

≥ Insert a recordable SD
card.

CANNOT RECORD
- INCOMPATIBLE
CONTROL DATA.

The content versions do not match.
This is displayed when the SD card
contains scenes recorded with
another device, for example.

≥ Match the device and
content version.

REC STOPPED. NOW
WRITING.

This is displayed when the SD card
is removed during recording or data
cannot be written to the SD card
correctly.

≥ Check the SD card.

ERROR OCCURRED.
PLEASE TURN UNIT OFF,
THEN TURN ON AGAIN.

This is displayed if the SD card is
removed or writing to the SD card
fails while recording is in progress.
It is also displayed when the lens of
the camera does not move.

≥ Check the SD card.
≥ Turn off and on this unit,
and then check to see if
the lens moves.

CANNOT RECORD.THE
NUMBER OF SCENES
HAS EXCEEDED THE
MAXIMUM LIMIT.

No additional scenes can be
recorded to the SD card.

≥ Delete unnecessary
scenes, or use a new SD
card.

CANNOT BE USED DUE
TO INCOMPATIBLE
DATA.
Cannot be used due to
incompatible data. Use
another card.

ERROR OCCURRED.
RECORDING IS
STOPPED.

- 206 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

Display
CANNOT RECORD
- DATE CAPACITY IS
FULL.

207 ページ 2016年11月28日

Description

月曜日

午前11時40分

Behavior and cause

This is displayed when you try to
record in excess of the maximum
number of scenes allowed for one
SD card.

≥ The operation will stop.
≥ Replace the SD card or
delete unnecessary
scenes.

INVALID

This is displayed when the operation
is invalid.

≥ Before performing the
operation, wait until this
unit is ready for it.

ERROR
- UNABLE TO REPAIR
DATA.

This is displayed when the
management information cannot be
recovered.

≥ Check the SD card.

Cannot record
- Playlist capacity is full.

CANNOT USE SD CARD
IN VIDEO MODE,
CONTROL DATA ERROR.

≥ The operation will stop.
≥ Use another SD card to
perform recording.

CONTROL DATA ERROR
HAS BEEN DETECTED.
(SD CARD)

Defective management information
has been found.

≥ The management
information will be
automatically recovered
after this message is
displayed.

SUPER SLOW MODE NO
AUDIO RECORDING

Audio cannot be recorded if you
record using Super Slow Recording.

≥ To record audio, disable
Super Slow Recording.

VFR ON,
NO AUDIO RECORDING

Audio cannot be recorded if you
change the frame rate when using
Variable Frame Rate Mode.

≥ To record audio, disable
Variable Frame Rate
Mode.

CANNOT PLAY.

This is displayed when an error in
the recording folder name or file
name has occurred, for example.

≥ Check the SD card.

CANNOT PLAY THIS
SCENE ON THIS MODEL.

The scene cannot be played back
because it was recorded with
another device.

≥ Play back the scene with
the device with which it
was recorded.

- 207 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

208 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

During thumbnail and menu operation
Display

Description

Behavior and cause

NO DATA.

There are no scenes in the
currently selected recording
mode option and recording
format option.

≥ Select a recording mode option
or recording format option
containing recorded scenes.

CANNOT DELETE.

The content versions do not
match. This is displayed when
you try to delete scenes
recorded with another device,
for example.

≥ Match the device and content
version.

CARD ERROR.
PLEASE REFORMAT.

This is displayed when the SD
card cannot be formatted.

≥ Check the SD card.
≥ Replace the SD card in the card
slot at which the error has
occurred.

UNABLE TO FORMAT.

Formatting is not possible due
to, for example, a problem with
the SD card.

≥ Check the SD card.

Cannot delete data on
card.

The SD card cannot be
formatted.

CANNOT PROTECT.

The content versions do not
match. This is displayed when
you try to set protection for
scenes recorded with another
device, for example.

≥ Match the device and content
version.

CANNOT RESET
NUMBER.

The SD card cannot be used
with this unit.

≥ Insert a recordable SD card.

THUMBNAIL RECOVERY
HAS FAILED.

This is displayed if the SD card
is removed or writing to the SD
card fails while recovery is in
progress.

≥ Check the SD card.

THUMBNAIL DATA
ERROR IS DETECTED.

This is displayed when
thumbnail information is not
recorded correctly.

≥ The applicable thumbnail
information will be recovered
after this message disappears.

CAN NOT SELECT MORE
SCENES.

The number of scenes that can
be selected with this unit has
reached the maximum limit.

≥ Reselect scenes after finishing
the current editing task.

SCENE FILE WRITE
FAILED

This is displayed if the SD card
is removed or writing to the SD
card fails while a scene file is
being saved.

≥ Check the SD card.

- 208 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

209 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

During USB Device mode
Display
DISCONNECT USB
CABLE.

Description
An error has occurred while
accessing the SD card, or the
OS is not supported.

Behavior and cause
≥ Check the SD card.
≥ Check to see if the OS is
supported.

During USB Host mode
Display

Description

Behavior and cause

This external media
cannot be used.
Disconnect the USB
cable from this unit.

This is displayed when the
memory capacity of the
external media is 32 GB or
below or above 2 TB.

≥ Connect a supported external
media.

CANNOT CHECK
CONNECTED DEVICE.
DISCONNECT THE USB
CABLE FROM THIS UNIT.

This is displayed when the
device is connected to this unit
with a product such as a USB
hub.

≥ Do not connect the devices with
a product such as a USB hub.
Connect to this unit directly.

FORMATTING FAILED.

The external media device
cannot be formatted.

≥ Change the connected external
media device.

Formatting failed.
Disconnect the USB
cable from this unit.

This is displayed when an
≥ Check the connected external
attempt to format the
media.
connected external media fails.

- 209 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

210 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

During copying between SD cards or copying to an external media device
Display

Description

Behavior and cause

PLEASE CHECK THE
EXTERNAL MEDIA.

Copying cannot be performed due
to, for example, a problem with the
copy destination media device.

≥ Check the copy destination
media device.

Use destination media
formatted with same as
SD card.

This is displayed when the SD
card and copy destination
media differ in their format
(FAT32/exFAT)*.
* FAT32 is a format used for
SDHC memory cards.
exFAT32 is a format used for
SDXC memory cards.

≥ Check the format of the copy
destination media.

CANNOT COPY.

This is displayed when AVCHD
scenes on the SD card and
those on the copy destination
media differ in their system
frequency (59.94 Hz/
50.00 Hz). (AVCHD scenes
with different system
frequencies cannot be
recorded to the same media.)

≥ Copy AVCHD scenes to a
recordable media so that their
system frequency and that of
AVCHD scenes on the media
match.

SELECTED SCENES
EXCEED CAPACITY.

The copy destination media
lacks adequate space.

≥ Change the copy destination
media, or delete unnecessary
scenes.

No scene to copy.

This is displayed when scenes
specified as copy sources
consist only of scenes
recorded with other devices.

≥ Use an SD card containing
scenes recorded with this unit.

THIS SCENE CANNOT
BE COPIED.

This is displayed when one or
more of the scenes you are
trying to copy cannot be played
back on this unit.

≥ Copy scenes except for the
ones that cannot be copied.

Cannot copy: contains
recordings from other
devices.

This is displayed when a copy- ≥ Copy only the scenes recorded
related operation involving a
with this unit.
scene recorded with another
device is performed.

CANNOT SELECT BY
DATE ANY MORE.

This is displayed when no
more scenes can be selected
after the maximum limit is
reached, for example.

Exceeds capacity. Please
reselect.

- 210 -

≥ After finishing copying, reselect
the desired dates.

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

Display
CANNOT COPY - DATE
CAPACITY IS FULL.
CANNOT COPY - THE
NUMBER OF SCENES
HAS REACHED
MAXIMUM.

211 ページ 2016年11月28日

Description
This is displayed when no
more scenes can be copied
after the maximum limit set by
applicable standards is
reached, for example.

COULD NOT COPY
SOME SCENES.

This is displayed when some
scenes cannot be copied after
the maximum limit set by
applicable standards is
reached, for example.

COPY FAILED. PLEASE
CHECK THE CARD.

An error has occurred while
accessing the SD card.

Cannot copy due to error
on media.

This is displayed when an
attempt to access the SD card
in this unit fails.

Cancel card lock to write
information.

The write-protect switch of the
copy destination SD card is
locked.

月曜日

午前11時40分

Behavior and cause
≥ Use an SD card with enough
recordable space.

≥ Check the SD card.

≥ Unlock the write-protect switch
of the SD card.

During wireless LAN connection
Display
Connection to wireless
access point failed.

Description
This is displayed when a
connection to the wireless
access point cannot be
established.

- 211 -

Behavior and cause
≥ Check the settings for [WIRELESS
SETUP] and [Wireless LAN setup],
and the settings on the wireless
access point.

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

212 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Display

Warning Indications
When an error is detected immediately after this unit is turned on or while it is being operated, the
status indicator, on-screen displays and the AG ROP application screen (during AG ROP
connection) inform you of the error.
Status indicator

It flashes once per second.

On-screen display

System error

AG ROP application screen

[ WARNING ] flashes four times per
second.

Meaning of the warning

A reference signal error or
communication error has occurred.

Recording/playback
Solution
Status indicator
On-screen display

The battery is
depleted
(Low input voltage)

AG ROP application screen
Meaning of the warning

The operation stops.
Turn off and on this unit. If the warning
persists, consult your dealer.
It flashes once per second.
The message [LOW BATTERY.] is
displayed.
[

WARNING

] lights up.

The battery is depleted.

Recording/playback

The operation stops. This unit turns off
automatically.

Solution

Charge or replace the battery.
Connect the AC adaptor to cancel the
warning.

Status indicator

The card is full

s

s

On-screen display

The remaining recordable time flashes
red when it reaches [R 0h00m].

AG ROP application screen

[ WARNING ] lights up until you perform
some operation after the recording.

Meaning of the warning
Recording/playback
Solution

- 212 -

The SD card capacity is full.
The recording stops.
Delete unnecessary scenes, or use a
new SD card.

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

213 ページ 2016年11月28日

Status indicator

月曜日

It flashes once per second.

On-screen display
AG ROP application screen
Recording error

s
[ WARNING ] flashes four times per
second.

Meaning of the warning

A recording error or recording circuit
setting error has occurred.

Recording/playback

The recording may either continue or
stop.

Solution

Turn off and on this unit. If the warning
persists, consult your dealer.

Status indicator
On-screen display
AG ROP application screen
Card error
Meaning of the warning

s
[

] is displayed.

[ WARNING ] flashes four times per
second.
An SD card error has occurred during
recording or playback.

Recording/playback

The operation stops.

Solution

Replace the SD card.

Status indicator
On-screen display

The battery will be
depleted soon

午前11時40分

AG ROP application screen
Meaning of the warning
Recording/playback

Solution

- 213 -

s
The message [CHANGE THE
BATTERY.] is displayed and
flashes red.
[

WARNING

] flashes once per second.

The battery will be depleted soon.
The operation continues.
Charge or replace the battery as
needed.
Connect the AC adaptor to cancel the
warning.

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

214 ページ 2016年11月28日

Status indicator

The card is nearly
full

午前11時40分

s

On-screen display

The remaining recordable time flashes
red. (When it is less than 1 minute)

AG ROP application screen

[ WARNING ] flashes once per second.
(When it is less than 1 minute)

Meaning of the warning
Recording/playback
Solution
Status indicator
On-screen display

The cooling fan has
stopped

月曜日

The SD card is almost out of space.
The recording continues.
Delete unnecessary scenes or use a
new SD card as needed.
It flashes twice per second.
s

AG ROP application screen

[ WARNING ] flashes four times per
second.

Meaning of the warning

A cooling fan error has stopped the
cooling fan.

Recording/playback

The operation stops and this unit turns
off automatically.

Solution

Check to see if the air inlet or outlet is
blocked. If the warning persists, consult
your dealer.

- 214 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

215 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Others

Troubleshooting
∫ It is not a malfunction in following cases
The lens, the viewfinder or
LCD monitor fog up.

≥ This is due to condensation. This is not a malfunction. Please
refer to page 8.

A clicking sound is heard
when the unit is shaken.

≥ This is the sound of the lens moving and is not a defect.
This sound will no longer be heard when the unit is turned on
and switch to Recording Mode.

Object seems to be warped. ≥ Object seems to be warped slightly when the object moves
across the image very fast, but this is because the unit is using
MOS for the image sensor. This is not a malfunction.

Power
Problem
This unit cannot be turned
on.
This unit does not stay on
long enough.

Check points
≥ Charge the battery again to ensure it is sufficiently charged.
(l 23)
≥ In cold places, the battery using time becomes shorter.
≥ The battery has a limited life. If the operating time is still too
short even after the battery is fully charged, the battery has
worn out and needs to be replaced.

Battery runs down quickly.
This unit cannot be
operated though it is
turned on.
This unit does not operate
normally.

“ERROR OCCURRED.
PLEASE TURN UNIT OFF,
THEN TURN ON AGAIN.”
is displayed.

≥ Remove the battery or AC adaptor, wait about 1 minute and
then reconnect the battery or AC adaptor. Then about
1 minute later, turn on the unit again. (Conducting the above
operation while the SD card is being accessed may damage
the data on the media.)
≥ If normal operation is still not restored, detach the power
connected, and consult the dealer who you purchased this
unit from.
≥ The unit has automatically detected an error. Restart the unit
by turning off and on.
≥ The unit will be turned off in about 1 minute if the unit is not
turned off and on.
≥ Repair is needed if it is repeatedly displayed even if it is
restarted. Detach the power connected, and consult the
dealer who you purchased this unit from. Do not attempt to
repair the unit by yourself.

- 215 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

216 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Indication
Problem
Function display
(Remaining Display,
Counter Display, etc.) is
not displayed.

Check points
≥ [CARD & BATTERY] or [OTHER DISPLAY] of the
[DISP SETUP] is [OFF]. (l 194)
≥ Press the COUNTER button to switch the counter display.
(l 78)

Recording
Problem

Check points

The unit arbitrarily stops
recording.

≥ Use an SD card that can be used for motion picture recording.
(l 29)
≥ The recordable time may have shortened due to the
deterioration of the data writing speed or repeated recording
and deletion. Using the unit, format the SD card. (l 42)

Auto Focus function does
not work.

≥ If you are trying to record a scene which is hard to bring into
focus in Auto Focus Mode, use the Manual Focus Mode to
adjust the focus. (l 45, 52)

Audio is not recorded.

≥ Super Slow Recording, Variable Frame Rate Mode, or
Interval Recording is enabled. (l 100, 182)
≥ When Super Slow Recording or Variable Frame Rate Mode is
enabled, A.REC is displayed and audio is not recorded.
≥ Audio is not recorded for Interval Recording.

Color or brightness of the
image changes, or you
may see horizontal bars in
the image.

≥ Color or brightness of the image may change, or you may see
horizontal bars in the image when the object is recorded
under fluorescent light, mercury light or sodium light, etc., but
this is not a malfunction.
≥ Record images in Auto Shutter Mode or adjust the shutter
speed to 1/50, 1/60 or 1/100.
≥ Adjust the Synchro Scan shutter speed. (l 73)

The LCD monitor flickers
indoors.

- 216 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

217 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Playback
Problem

Check points

Scenes/still pictures
cannot be played back.

≥ Any scenes/still pictures where the thumbnails are displayed
as
cannot be played back.
≥ In most cases,
is displayed for the following scenes:
j Scenes recorded with another device or edited with editing
software
j Scenes with damaged data
≥ The thumbnails of scenes recorded on other devices with
different system frequencies are indicated with
. You
can play them back by changing the [SYSTEM FREQ]
setting. (l 197)

Scenes/still pictures
cannot be deleted.

≥ Release the protect setting. (l 122)
≥ It may not be possible to delete the following scenes/still
pictures:
j Any scenes/still pictures where the thumbnails are
displayed as
If the scenes/still pictures are unnecessary, format the SD
card to erase the data. (l 42) Please be aware that if a SD
card is formatted then all the data recorded on the SD card is
erased and cannot be recovered. Back up important data on a
PC etc.

With other products
Problem
Although this unit is
correctly connected to an
external monitor, images
cannot be seen.

Check points
≥ Please read the operating instructions of your external
monitor and select the channel that matches the input used
for the connection.
≥ Change the setting of the unit depending on the cable
connecting to the external monitor. (l 128)

The images are squeezed
horizontally.
Even when this unit is
connected to the external
monitor by the HDMI
cable, images or sounds
are not output.

≥ Check if the HDMI cable is connected correctly.
≥ Insert the HDMI cable all the way in.

If the SD card is inserted in
another device, it is not
recognized.

≥ Check that the device is compatible with the capacity or type
of SD card (SDHC Memory Card/SDXC Memory Card) that
you inserted. Refer to the operating instructions of the device
for details.

When connected by the
USB Cable, this unit is not
detected by the other
devices.

≥ When connected to other devices using only the battery,
reconnect using the AC adaptor.

- 217 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

218 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

With a PC
Problem

Check points

When connected by the
USB Cable, this unit is not
detected by the PC.

≥ After re-inserting the SD card into the unit, reconnect the USB
Cable.
≥ Select another USB terminal on the PC.
≥ Check the operating environment. (l 132)
≥ Connect the USB Cable again after restarting the PC and
turning on this unit again.

When the USB Cable is
disconnected, an error
message will appear on
the PC.

≥ To disconnect the USB Cable safely, double-click the
icon in the task tray and follow the instructions on the screen.

Others
Problem

Check points

If the SD card is inserted in
this unit, it is not
recognized.

≥ If the SD card is formatted on a PC, it may not be recognized
by this unit. Use this unit to format SD cards. (l 42)

∫ If AVCHD scenes do not change smoothly when played back on
another device
The images may be still for several seconds at the joins between the scenes if the following
operations are performed when multiple scenes have been continuously played back using another
device.
≥ Just how smoothly the scenes will be played back depends on the playback device. Depending
on the device used, the images may stop moving and become still for a moment even when none
of the following conditions are applicable.
≥ A continuous recording of motion picture data that exceeds 4 GB may momentarily stop at every
4 GB of data when played back with another device.
Principal reasons for not playing back smoothly
≥ The recording format [PS] was switched to another recording format when a scene was
recorded
≥ When the scenes were recorded on different dates
≥ When scenes lasting under 3 seconds have been recorded
≥ When PRE-REC was used for recording
≥ When the Interval Recording is used
≥ When deleting scenes
≥ When scenes recorded more than 99 scenes on the same date

- 218 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

219 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

About recovery
If faulty management information is found, the messages may appear and a repair is performed.
(Repairing may take time depending on the error.)
≥
is displayed when abnormal management information is detected when the scenes are
displayed in thumbnail.
Use a sufficiently charged battery or the AC adaptor.
Depending on the condition of the data, it may not be possible to completely repair the data.
If recovery fails, it will not be possible to play back scenes recorded before the unit turned off.
When data recorded on another device is recovered, it may not be possible to play back the data
on this unit or the other device.
≥ If recovery fails, turn the unit off and on again after waiting awhile. If recovery fails repeatedly,
format a media on the unit. Please be aware that if a media is formatted, then all the data
recorded on the media will be erased.
≥ If the thumbnail information is recovered, displaying the thumbnails may become slower.
≥
≥
≥
≥

- 219 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

220 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Others

About copyright
∫ Carefully observe copyright
laws
Recording of pre-recorded tapes or discs or
other published or broadcast material for
purposes other than your own private use
may infringe copyright laws. Even for the
purpose of private use, recording of certain
material may be restricted.

∫ Licenses
≥ SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.
≥ “AVCHD”, “AVCHD Progressive” and the
“AVCHD Progressive” logo are trademarks of
Panasonic Corporation and Sony
Corporation.
≥ Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
≥ The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia
Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trademarks or
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing, LLC in the
United States and other countries.
≥ LEICA is a registered trademark of Leica
Microsystems IR GmbH.
≥ DICOMAR is a registered trademark of Leica
Camera AG.
≥ Microsoft® and Windows® are either
registered trademarks or trademarks of
Microsoft Corporation in the United States
and/or other countries.
≥ Microsoft product screen shot(s) reprinted
with permission from Microsoft Corporation.
≥ Intel®, Pentium®, Celeron® and Intel®Core™
are trademarks of Intel Corporation in the
U.S. and/or other countries.
≥ Final Cut Pro, Mac and macOS are
trademarks of Apple Inc. registered in the
U.S. and other countries.
≥ iPad is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered
in the U.S. and other countries.
≥ App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.
≥ “Wi-Fi®” is a registered trademark of Wi-Fi
Alliance®.
≥ “WPA™”, and “WPA2™” are trademarks of
Wi-Fi Alliance®.

≥ Other names of systems and products
mentioned in these instructions are usually
the registered trademarks or trademarks of
the manufacturers who developed the system
or product concerned.
This product is licensed under the AVC Patent
Portfolio License for the personal use of a
consumer or other uses in which it does not
receive remuneration to (i) encode video in
compliance with the AVC Standard (“AVC
Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC Video that was
encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal
activity and/or was obtained from a video
provider licensed to provide AVC Video. No
license is granted or shall be implied for any
other use. Additional information may be
obtained from MPEG LA, L.L.C.
See http://www.mpegla.com

- 220 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

221 ページ 2016年11月28日

This product incorporates the following software:
(1) the software developed independently by or
for Panasonic Corporation,
(2) the software owned by third party and
licensed to Panasonic Corporation,
(3) the software licensed under the GNU
General Public License, Version 2.0 (GPL
V2.0),
(4) the software licensed under the GNU
LESSER General Public License, Version 2.1
(LGPL V2.1), and/or
(5) open source software other than the software
licensed under the GPL V2.0 and/or LGPL V2.1.
The software categorized as (3) - (5) are
distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, without even the
implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Refer
to the detailed terms and conditions thereof, which
can be accessed by selecting [SOFTWARE INFO]
in “Other Functions” as described in “Using the
Menu” in the Operating Instructions (PDF format).
At least three (3) years from delivery of this
product, Panasonic will give to any third party who
contacts us at the contact information provided
below, for a charge no more than our cost of
physically performing source code distribution, a
complete machine-readable copy of the
corresponding source code covered under GPL
V2.0 or LGPL V2.1, as well as the respective
copyright notice thereof.
Contact Information:
oss-cd-request@gg.jp.panasonic.com
The source code and the copyright notice are
also available for free in our website below.
http://panasonic.net/avc/oss/index.html

- 221 -

月曜日

午前11時40分

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

222 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Others

Recording functions that cannot be
used simultaneously
Due to the specifications of this unit, depending on the recording function being used, it is not
possible to use or select certain other recording functions.
≥ “±”: Available; “s”: Not available*
* “Not available” includes instances where the desired function cannot be used or selected.
Recording
function to be
set

Currently set recording function
Interval
Rec

Interval Rec (l 182)
Super Slow
Recording
(l 103, 183)
VFR Mode

Super Slow
Relay
Simultaneous Background
VFR Mode
Recording
recording
recording
recording

s
s

Dual codec
recording

s

s

±

s

s

s

s

±

s

s

s

±

s

s

s

s

s

s

s

s

s

Relay recording
(l 177)

s

s

s

Simultaneous
recording (l 177)

±

±

±

s

Background
recording (l 177)

s

s

s

s

s

Dual codec recording
(l 177)

s

s

s

s

s

s

PRE-REC (l 95, 183)

s

s

s

±

±

s

±

Black Fade (l 86)

s

s

s

±

±

±

±

White Fade (l 86)

s

s

s

±

±

±

±

Time Stamp (l 184)

±

s

s

±

±

±

s

Recording Check
(l 88)

s

±

±

±

s

s

±

Last Scene Delete
(l 88)

s

±

±

±

s

s

s

(l 100, 183)

- 222 -

s

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

223 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Others

Recording modes/approximate
recordable time
≥ SD cards are only mentioned with their main memory size. The stated times are the approximate
recordable times for continuous recording.
≥ “h” is an abbreviation for hour, “min” for minute and “s” for second.
≥ If recording for long periods, prepare batteries for 3 or 4 times the period you wish to record for.
(l 26)
≥ The default setting for [REC MODE] is [MP4], and the default setting for [REC FORMAT] is [UHD
2160/50.00p 150M].
≥ Maximum continuously recordable time for one scene: 10 hours*
≥ The recording is paused once when the recording time for one scene exceeds 10 hours, and the
recording will automatically resume after a few seconds.*
≥ For information on the maximum continuous recordable time for one scene during Super Slow
Recording, refer to page 104.
≥ For information on the maximum continuous recordable time for one scene in Variable Frame
Rate Mode, refer to page 102.
≥ The recordable time may be reduced if recording with a lot of action is recorded or recording of
short scene is repeated.
≥ The recordable times depends on the recording condition or card type to be recorded.
≥ For information on picture sizes, frame rates, and bit rates in [REC FORMAT], refer to page 161.
* The time also applies to scenes recorded with [RELAY REC] in [2 SLOTS FUNC.]. (l 178)
≥ When [REC MODE] is set to [MOV] or [MP4]
Recording format

System frequency
setting (l 160)

[4K 2160/24.00p 100M]

[59.94Hz]/
[50.00Hz]

[UHD 2160/59.94p 150M]
[UHD 2160/29.97p 100M]
[UHD 2160/23.98p 100M]
[FHD 1080/59.94p

]

[FHD 1080/29.97p

]

[FHD 1080/23.98p

]

4 GB

16 GB

64 GB

s

20 min

1 h 20 min

s

s

55 min

s

20 min

1 h 20 min

10 min

40 min

s

[FHD 1080/59.94p 100M]
[FHD 1080/59.94p 50M]

SD card

[59.94Hz]

20 min

1 h 20 min

10 min

40 min

2 h 40 min

s

10 min

40 min

10 min

40 min

2 h 40 min

[FHD 1080/29.97p 50M]
[FHD 1080/23.98p 50M]
[FHD 1080/59.94i 50M]

- 223 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

224 ページ 2016年11月28日

System frequency
setting (l 160)

Recording format

月曜日

午前11時40分

SD card
4 GB

16 GB

64 GB

[UHD 2160/50.00p 150M]

s

s

55 min

[UHD 2160/25.00p 100M]

s

20 min

1 h 20 min

[FHD 1080/50.00p

]

s

10 min

40 min

[FHD 1080/50.00p 100M]

s

20 min

1 h 20 min

10 min

40 min

2 h 40 min

s

10 min

40 min

10 min

40 min

2 h 40 min

[FHD 1080/50.00p 50M]
[FHD 1080/25.00p

[50.00Hz]

]

[FHD 1080/25.00p 50M]
[FHD 1080/50.00i 50M]
≥ When [REC MODE] is set to [AVCHD]
Recording format

System frequency
setting (l 160)

[PS 1080/59.94p]
[PH 1080/59.94i]
[PH 1080/23.98p]
[HA 1080/59.94i]

[59.94Hz]

SD card
4 GB

16 GB

64 GB

19 min

1 h 20 min

5 h 20 min

21 min

1 h 30 min

6h

30 min

2h

8 h 30 min

[HE 1080/59.94i]

1 h 30 min

6 h 40 min

27 h 30 min

[PM 720/59.94p]

1h

4 h 15 min

17 h 10 min

[SA 480/59.94i]

1h

4h

16 h 30 min

[PS 1080/50.00p]

19 min

1 h 20 min

5 h 20 min

[PH 1080/50.00i]

21 min

1 h 30 min

6h

[HA 1080/50.00i]

30 min

2h

8 h 30 min

1 h 30 min

6 h 40 min

27 h 30 min

[PM 720/50.00p]

1h

4 h 15 min

17 h 10 min

[SA 576/50.00i]

1h

4h

16 h 30 min

[HE 1080/50.00i]

[50.00Hz]

- 224 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

225 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Others

Approximate number of recordable
pictures
≥ SD cards are only mentioned with their main memory size. The stated number is the approximate
number of recordable pictures.
Picture size

Aspect ratio

8.8M 4096k2160

17:9

SD card

8.3M 3840k2160
2.1 M 1920k1080

16:9

0.9M 1280k720

4 GB

16 GB

64 GB

700

2900

11500

750

3000

12000

3200

12500

52000

7000

29000

118000

≥ Maximum number of recordable pictures that can be displayed is 9999. If the number of
recordable pictures exceeds 9999, R 9999+ is displayed. The number will not change when the
picture is taken until the number of recordable pictures is 9999 or less.
≥ The number of recordable pictures depends on the recording condition or card type to be
recorded.
≥ The memory capacity indicated on the label of an SD card is the total of the capacity for copyright
protection and management and the capacity which can be used on the unit, a PC etc.

- 225 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

226 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Others

Specification
4K Video Camera

General

Camera unit

Power:
DC 7.28 V (When using battery)
DC 12 V (When using AC adaptor)
Power consumption:
19.7 W (When using LCD monitor)
indicates safety information
Ambient operating temperature:
0 oC to 40 oC
Ambient operating humidity:
10%RH to 80%RH (no condensation)
Mass:
Approx. 2.0 kg
(body only, excluding lens hood, battery, and
accessories)
Approx. 2.4 kg
(including lens hood, supplied battery, and eye cup)
Dimensions (WkHkD):
173 mmk195 mmk346 mm
(excluding eye cup and projecting parts)

Pickup device:
1.0-type (effective size) MOS solid state image
sensor
Number of pixels:
FHD (1920k1080), UHD (3840k2160);
8.79 million pixels
4K (4096k2160) 24.00p; 9.46 million pixels
Lens:
Optical image stabilizer lens, optical 20k
motorized zoom
F value (focal length)
F2.8 to F4.5 (f=8.8 mm to 176 mm)
35 mm conversion
FHD (1920k1080), UHD (3840k2160);
25.4 mm to 508.0 mm
4K (4096k2160) 24.00p;
24.0 mm to 480.0 mm
Filter diameter; 67 mm
ND filter; OFF, 1/4, 1/16, 1/64
Shortest shooting distance (M.O.D);
1.0 m from the lens
IR filter; incorporates the ON/OFF control
function
Gain setting:
L/M/H selector button (toggle button)
In normal mode; 0 dB to 24 dB
When [EXTENDED SENSITIVITY] is enabled;
j3 dB to 24 dB
≥ Adjustable in 1 dB steps (automatic setting
can also be assigned to L/M/H.)
≥ When assigning [SUPER GAIN] to the USER
button: 30 dB or 36 dB
Color temperature setting:
[ATW], [ATW LOCK], [Ach], [Bch],
preset 3200K, preset 5600K, VAR (2000K to
15000K)

- 226 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

227 ページ 2016年11月28日

Shutter speed:
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz]
≥ 60i/60p mode;
1/60, 1/100, 1/120, 1/180, 1/250, 1/350,
1/500, 1/750, 1/1000, 1/1500, 1/2000,
1/3000, 1/4000, 1/8000 sec.
≥ 30p mode;
1/30, 1/50, 1/60, 1/100, 1/120, 1/180, 1/250,
1/350, 1/500, 1/750, 1/1000, 1/1500, 1/2000,
1/3000, 1/4000, 1/8000 sec.
≥ 24p mode;
1/24, 1/48, 1/50, 1/60, 1/100, 1/120, 1/180,
1/250, 1/350, 1/500, 1/750, 1/1000, 1/1500,
1/2000, 1/3000, 1/4000, 1/8000 sec.
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz]
≥ 50i/50p mode;
1/50, 1/60, 1/100, 1/125, 1/180, 1/250,
1/350, 1/500, 1/750, 1/1000, 1/1500, 1/2000,
1/3000, 1/4000, 1/8000 sec.
≥ 25p mode;
1/25, 1/50, 1/60, 1/100, 1/125, 1/180, 1/250,
1/350, 1/500, 1/750, 1/1000, 1/1500, 1/2000,
1/3000, 1/4000, 1/8000 sec.
Slow shutter speed:
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz]
≥ 60i/60p mode;
1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/15, 1/30 sec.
≥ 30p mode;
1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/15 sec.
≥ 24p mode;
1/2, 1/3, 1/6, 1/12 sec.
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz]
≥ 50i/50p mode;
1/2, 1/3, 1/6, 1/12, 1/25 sec.
≥ 25p mode;
1/2, 1/3, 1/6, 1/12 sec.
Synchro scan shutter:
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz]
≥ 59.94i/59.94p;
1/60.0 to 1/249.7 sec.
≥ 29.97p;
1/30.0 to 1/249.7 sec.
≥ 23.98p;
1/24.0 to 1/249.6 sec.
≥ 24.00p;
1/24.0 to 1/249.9 sec.

月曜日

午前11時40分

When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz]
≥ 50i/50p;
1/50.0 to 1/250.0 sec.
≥ 25p;
1/25.0 to 1/250.0 sec.
VFR recording frame rate:
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz]
≥ 30p mode;
2, 15, 26, 28, 30, 32, 34, 45, 60 (fps)
≥ 24p mode;
2, 12, 20, 22, 24, 26, 28, 36, 48, 60 (fps)
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz]
≥ 25p mode;
2, 12, 21, 23, 25, 27, 30, 37, 50 (fps)
Super Slow Recording:
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz]
Recording frame rate; FHD 120 fps
Slow motion effect;
1/4 the normal speed (30p mode),
1/5 the normal speed (24p mode)
When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz]
Recording frame rate; FHD 100 fps
Slow motion effect;
1/4 the normal speed (25p mode)
Sensitivity:
When [HIGH SENS. MODE] = [HIGH SENS.]
F11 (2000 lx, 3200 K, 89.9% reflection,
1080/59.94i)
F12 (2000 lx, 3200 K, 89.9% reflection,
1080/50.00i)
Minimum subject illumination:
0.2 lx (F2.8, gain 18 dB,
shutter speed 1/2 sec.,
when [HIGH SENS. MODE] = [HIGH SENS.])
Digital zoom:
2k/5k/10k/i.Zoom (max. 30k)
Lens hood:
Hood with lens cover

- 227 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

228 ページ 2016年11月28日

Memory card recorder
Recording media:
SDHC Memory Card (4 GB to 32 GB)/
SDXC Memory Card (48 GB to 128 GB);
UHS-I supported
Refer to page 29 for details on SD cards usable
in this unit.
Recording slots:
2 slots
System frequency:
59.94 Hz, 50.00 Hz
Motion picture recording:
Recording method; MOV, MP4, AVCHD
Recording format;
≥ When [REC MODE] = [MOV], [MP4]
[4K 2160/24.00p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz])
[UHD 2160/59.94p 150M];
Average 150 Mbps (VBR)
[UHD 2160/29.97p 100M]/
[UHD 2160/23.98p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/59.94p
]/
[FHD 1080/29.97p
]/
[FHD 1080/23.98p
];
Average 200 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/59.94p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/59.94p 50M]/
[FHD 1080/29.97p 50M]/
[FHD 1080/23.98p 50M]/
[FHD 1080/59.94i 50M];
Average 50 Mbps (VBR)
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz])
[UHD 2160/50.00p 150M];
Average 150 Mbps (VBR)
[UHD 2160/25.00p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/50.00p
]/
[FHD 1080/25.00p
];
Average 200 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/50.00p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/50.00p 50M]/
[FHD 1080/25.00p 50M]/
[FHD 1080/50.00i 50M];
Average 50 Mbps (VBR)

月曜日

午前11時40分

≥ When [REC MODE] = [AVCHD]
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [59.94Hz])
[PS 1080/59.94p]; Average 25 Mbps (VBR)
[PH 1080/59.94i]; Average 21 Mbps (VBR)
[PH 1080/23.98p]; Average 21 Mbps (VBR)
[HA 1080/59.94i]; Average 17 Mbps (VBR)
[HE 1080/59.94i]; Average 5 Mbps (VBR)
[PM 720/59.94p]; Average 8 Mbps (VBR)
[SA 480/59.94i]
(When [ASPECT CONVERT] = [SIDE
CROP], [SQUEEZE]);
Average 9 Mbps (VBR)
(When [SYSTEM FREQ] = [50.00Hz])
[PS 1080/50.00p]; Average 25 Mbps (VBR)
[PH 1080/50.00i]; Average 21 Mbps (VBR)
[HA 1080/50.00i]; Average 17 Mbps (VBR)
[HE 1080/50.00i]; Average 5 Mbps (VBR)
[PM 720/50.00p]; Average 8 Mbps (VBR)
[SA 576/50.00i]
(When [ASPECT CONVERT] = [SIDE
CROP], [SQUEEZE]);
Average 9 Mbps (VBR)
Refer to page 161 and 223 for the picture size
and recordable time of a motion picture.
Still picture recording:
Recording method;
JPEG corresponding DCF (Design rule for
Camera File system, based on Exif 2.2 standard)
Refer to page 225 for picture size of a still
picture and number of recordable pictures.
2 Slot function:
Relay, simultaneous, background*1, dual codec
*1 Available with a recording format of
50 Mbps or less

- 228 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

229 ページ 2016年11月28日

Digital video
Video signal for external output:
8 bit 4:2:2*2
*2 It is set to 8 bit 4:2:0 when UHD 59.94p or
UHD 50.00p is selected.
Recording video signal:
8 bit 4:2:0
Video compression format:
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 High Profile
(MOV/MP4/AVCHD)

Digital audio
Recording audio signal:
48 kHz/16 bit 2CH
Audio compression format:
Linear PCM (MOV/MP4), Dolby Digital
(AVCHD)
Headroom:
12 dB

Dual codec
Recording method:
MOV, MP4
Video compression format:
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 High Profile
Audio compression format:
Linear PCM
Recording format:
When [DUAL CODEC REC] = [FHD 50Mbps]
≥ For main recording
[REC MODE] = [MOV]/[MP4]
[UHD 2160/29.97p 100M],
[UHD 2160/25.00p 100M],
[UHD 2160/23.98p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
≥ For sub recording
[REC MODE] = [MOV]/[MP4]*3
FHD 29.97p, 25.00p, 23.98p*4;
Average 50 Mbps (VBR)

月曜日

午前11時40分

When [DUAL CODEC REC] = [FHD 8Mbps]
≥ For main recording
[REC MODE] = [MOV]/[MP4]
[UHD 2160/29.97p 100M],
[UHD 2160/25.00p 100M],
[UHD 2160/23.98p 100M],
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/59.94p
],
[FHD 1080/50.00p
],
[FHD 1080/29.97p
],
[FHD 1080/25.00p
],
[FHD 1080/23.98p
];
Average 200 Mbps (VBR)
[FHD 1080/59.94p 100M],
[FHD 1080/50.00p 100M];
Average 100 Mbps (VBR)
≥ For sub recording
[REC MODE] = [MOV]
FHD 59.94p, 50.00p, 29.97p, 25.00p,
23.98p*4;
Average 8 Mbps (VBR)
*3 It records motion picture with the same
[REC MODE] setting selected for main
recording.
*4 It records motion picture in the same
frame rate as that of the [REC FORMAT]
setting selected for main recording.

Video input/output
VIDEO OUT terminal:
VIDEO OUT terminal k1
HDMI OUT terminal:
HDMIk1,
(HDMI Type A, not compatible with
VIERA Link)
Output format;
2160/59.94p/50.00p/29.97p/25.00p/24.00p/
23.98p, 1080/59.94p/50.00p/29.97p/25.00p/
24.00p/23.98p/59.94i/50.00i, 720/59.94p/
50.00p, 480/59.94p, 576/50.00p

- 229 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

230 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

Audio input

Other input/output

Built-in microphone:
Supports stereo microphone
AUDIO INPUT1/AUDIO INPUT2 terminal:
XLRk2, 3-pin
Input high impedance, LINE/MIC/MIC_48 V
(switch selection)
≥ LINE; _4 dBu/0 dBu (selectable menu)
≥ MIC; `40 dBu /`50 dBu /`60 dBu
(selectable menu)

CAM REMOTE terminal:
2.5 mm diameter super mini jackk1
(ZOOM, S/S)
3.5 mm diameter mini jackk1 (FOCUS, IRIS)
USB HOST terminal:
Type A connector, 9-pin
In Recording mode;
USB 2.0 compatible (5 V, 0.5 A)
In Playback mode;
USB 3.0 compatible (5 V, 0.9 A), used for
external media device connection*5, bus
power supported
*5 External media device with a capacity of
32 GB or below or a capacity above 2 TB
cannot be used
USB DEVICE terminal:
Type Micro B connector, 10-pin, USB 3.0
compatible, used for the mass storage function
(read only)
DC input terminal:
DC 12 V (DC 11.4 V to 12.6 V), EIAJ type 4

Audio output
HDMI OUT terminal:
2ch (Linear PCM)
AUDIO OUT terminal:
AUDIO OUT terminal k2
Output level; 251 mV
Output impedance; 600 h
Headphone output terminal:
3.5 mm diameter stereo mini jackk1
Speaker:
Round type speaker with a diameter of
20 mm k1

Monitor
LCD monitor:
8.8 cm (3.5 q) liquid crystal monitor
(Approx. 1150000 dots)
Viewfinder:
1.0 cm (0.39 q) OLED (organic EL display)
(Approx. 2360000 dots, video display area;
Approx. 1770000 dots)

- 230 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

231 ページ 2016年11月28日

AC adaptor
Power source:
AC
100 V to 240 V,
50 Hz/60 Hz, 1.2 A
Power output:
DC
12 V, 3.0 A

月曜日

午前11時40分

Battery charger
Input voltage:
DC
12 V, 3.0 A
Output voltage:
DC
8.4 V, 4.0 A
indicates safety information

indicates safety information
Ambient operating temperature:
0 oC to 40 oC
Ambient operating humidity:
10%RH to 90%RH (no condensation)
Mass:
Approx. 225 g
Dimensions (WkHkD):
115 mmk37 mmk57 mm
(Excluding the DC cord portion)

Charging current:
Max. 4000 mA
Ambient operating temperature:
0 oC to 40 oC
Ambient operating humidity:
10%RH to 80%RH (no condensation)
Mass:
Approx. 230 g
Dimensions (WkHkD):
130 mmk48 mmk107 mm
The symbols on this product (including the
accessories) represent the following:
AC
DC
Class II equipment (The construction of
the product is double-insulated.)

- 231 -

HC-X1_E_GC_DVQP1176ZA_eng.book

232 ページ 2016年11月28日

月曜日

午前11時40分

EU
Manufactured by:

Panasonic Corporation
Kadoma, Osaka, Japan
Importer for Europe: Panasonic Marketing Europe GmbH
Panasonic Testing Centre
Winsbergring 15, 22525 Hamburg, Germany

Panasonic Corporation
Web site: http://www.panasonic.com
© Panasonic Corporation 2016



Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.6
Linearized                      : Yes
Page Mode                       : UseOutlines
XMP Toolkit                     : Adobe XMP Core 4.0-c321 44.398116, Tue Aug 04 2009 14:24:39
Modify Date                     : 2016:11:30 14:18:35+09:00
Create Date                     : 2016:11:28 11:44:37+09:00
Metadata Date                   : 2016:11:30 14:18:35+09:00
Format                          : application/pdf
Title                           : HC-X1
Creator                         : Panasonic Corporation
Document ID                     : uuid:63f44df2-5343-4726-9a34-7e87fb03213f
Instance ID                     : uuid:c2bc43b0-36f1-486e-8f61-5dd09ec4b904
Page Count                      : 232
Page Layout                     : OneColumn
Author                          : Panasonic Corporation
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools

Navigation menu